debug: Improve mqueue.h fortify warnings with clang
[glibc.git] / manual / texinfo.tex
blobd272d2adc376c17e5239b36c6fe479a6592fbb13
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2018-12-28.17}
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
11 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
12 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
13 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
15 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
16 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
17 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
18 % General Public License for more details.
20 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 % along with this program. If not, see <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
23 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
24 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
25 % restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
26 % of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
28 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
29 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
30 % https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
31 % https://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
32 % https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
33 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
34 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
36 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
37 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
38 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
40 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
41 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
42 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
43 % tex foo.texi
44 % texindex foo.??
45 % tex foo.texi
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
48 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
49 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
50 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
52 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
53 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
54 % full Texinfo distribution.
56 % The GNU Texinfo home page is https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
59 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
61 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
62 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
63 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
64 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
65 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
67 % LaTeX's \typeout. This ensures that the messages it is used for
68 % are identical in format to the corresponding ones from latex/pdflatex.
69 \def\typeout{\immediate\write17}%
71 \chardef\other=12
73 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
74 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
75 \let\+ = \relax
77 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
78 \let\ptexb=\b
79 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
80 \let\ptexc=\c
81 \let\ptexcomma=\,
82 \let\ptexdot=\.
83 \let\ptexdots=\dots
84 \let\ptexend=\end
85 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
86 \let\ptexexclam=\!
87 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
88 \let\ptexgtr=>
89 \let\ptexhat=^
90 \let\ptexi=\i
91 \let\ptexindent=\indent
92 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
93 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
94 \let\ptexless=<
95 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
96 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
97 \let\ptexplus=+
98 \let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
99 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
100 \let\ptexslash=\/
101 \let\ptexsp=\sp
102 \let\ptexstar=\*
103 \let\ptexsup=\sup
104 \let\ptext=\t
105 \let\ptextop=\top
106 {\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
108 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
109 % starts a new line in the output.
110 \newlinechar = `^^J
112 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
113 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
115 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
116 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
117 \else
118 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
121 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
122 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
124 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
156 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
157 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
158 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
159 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
160 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
162 % Give the space character the catcode for a space.
163 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =10\relax}
165 % Likewise for ^^M, the end of line character.
166 \def\endlineisspace{\catcode13=10\relax}
168 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
169 \chardef\slashChar = `\/
170 \chardef\underChar = `\_
172 % Ignore a token.
174 \def\gobble#1{}
176 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
177 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
179 % Hyphenation fixes.
180 \hyphenation{
181 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
182 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
183 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
184 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
185 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
186 spell-ing spell-ings
187 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
188 wide-spread wrap-around
191 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
192 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
193 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
194 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
195 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
197 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
198 \def\loggingall{%
199 \tracingstats2
200 \tracingpages1
201 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
202 \tracingparagraphs1
203 \tracingoutput1
204 \tracingmacros2
205 \tracingrestores1
206 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
207 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
208 \tracingscantokens1
209 \tracingifs1
210 \tracinggroups1
211 \tracingnesting2
212 \tracingassigns1
214 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
215 \errorcontextlines16
218 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
219 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
220 % after all.
222 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
223 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
225 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
226 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
228 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
229 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
230 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
231 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
232 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
233 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
235 %\f Output routine
238 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
239 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
240 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
242 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
244 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
245 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
247 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
248 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
249 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
251 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
252 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
254 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
255 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
256 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.
258 % \domark is called twice inside \chapmacro, to add one
259 % mark before the section break, and one after.
260 % In the second call \prevchapterdefs is the same as \lastchapterdefs,
261 % and \prevsectiondefs is the same as \lastsectiondefs.
262 % Then if the page is not broken at the mark, some of the previous
263 % section appears on the page, and we can get the name of this section
264 % from \firstmark for @everyheadingmarks top.
265 % @everyheadingmarks bottom uses \botmark.
267 % See page 260 of The TeXbook.
268 \def\domark{%
269 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
270 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
271 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
272 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
273 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
274 \mark{%
275 \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: marks for @everyheadingmarks top
276 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: for @everyheadingmarks bottom
277 \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
281 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks,
282 % \getcolormarks - extract needed part of mark.
284 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
285 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
286 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
287 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
288 % first @chapter.
289 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
290 \ifcase0\topmark\fi
291 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
293 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
294 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
296 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
297 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
298 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
299 \def\lastsection{}
300 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
301 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
302 \def\lastcolordefs{}
304 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
305 \newdimen\bindingoffset
306 \newdimen\normaloffset
307 \newdimen\txipagewidth \newdimen\txipageheight
309 % Main output routine.
311 \chardef\PAGE = 255
312 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
314 \newbox\headlinebox
315 \newbox\footlinebox
317 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.
318 % \shipout a vbox for a single page, adding an optional header, footer
319 % and footnote. This also causes index entries for this page to be written
320 % to the auxiliary files.
322 \def\onepageout#1{%
323 \hoffset=\normaloffset
325 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
326 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
328 % Common context changes for both heading and footing.
329 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
330 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
331 \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\txipagewidth \texinfochars}
333 % Retrieve the information for the headings from the marks in the page,
334 % and call Plain TeX's \makeheadline and \makefootline, which use the
335 % values in \headline and \footline.
337 % This is used to check if we are on the first page of a chapter.
338 \ifcase1\topmark\fi
339 \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
340 \ifcase0\firstmark\fi
341 \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
343 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
344 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
346 \ifx\curchaptername\prevchaptername
347 \let\thischapterheading\thischapter
348 \else
349 % \thischapterheading is the same as \thischapter except it is blank
350 % for the first page of a chapter. This is to prevent the chapter name
351 % being shown twice.
352 \def\thischapterheading{}%
355 \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
356 \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}%
359 % Set context for writing to auxiliary files like index files.
360 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
361 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
362 % before the \shipout runs.
364 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
365 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
366 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
367 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
368 % \entry{{\indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
369 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
370 % it needs to be
371 % {\code {{\backslashcurfont }acronym}
372 \shipout\vbox{%
373 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
374 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
376 \unvbox\headlinebox
377 \pagebody{#1}%
378 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
379 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
380 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
381 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
382 \vskip 24pt
383 \unvbox\footlinebox
386 }% end of \shipout\vbox
387 }% end of group with \indexdummies
388 \advancepageno
389 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
392 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
394 % Main part of page, including any footnotes
395 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\txipageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
396 {\catcode`\@ =11
397 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
398 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
399 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
400 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
401 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
402 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
403 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
407 % Argument parsing
409 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
410 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
411 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
412 % For example, \def\foo{\parsearg\fooxxx}.
414 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
415 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
416 \def\argtorun{#2}%
417 \begingroup
418 \obeylines
419 \spaceisspace
421 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
424 {\obeylines %
425 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
426 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
427 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
431 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. Also remove a @texinfoc
432 % comment (see \scanmacro for details). Pass the result on to \argcheckspaces.
433 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
434 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argremovetexinfoc #1\texinfoc\ArgTerm}
435 \def\argremovetexinfoc#1\texinfoc#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
437 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
439 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
440 % @end itemize @c foo
441 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
442 % by \finishparsearg.
444 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
445 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
446 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
447 \def\temp{#3}%
448 \ifx\temp\empty
449 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
450 \let\temp\finishparsearg
451 \else
452 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
454 % Put the space token in:
455 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
458 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
459 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
460 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
461 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
462 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
463 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
464 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
466 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
468 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
471 % \parseargdef - define a command taking an argument on the line
473 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
474 % is roughly equivalent to
475 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
476 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
477 \def\parseargdef#1{%
478 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
480 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
481 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
482 \def#1##1%
485 % Several utility definitions with active space:
487 \obeyspaces
488 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
490 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
491 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
492 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
493 % should produce a line of output anyway.
495 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
497 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
498 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
499 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
500 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
504 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
506 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
508 % \envdef\foo{...}
509 % \def\Efoo{...}
511 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
512 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
513 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
514 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
515 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
517 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
518 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
519 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
520 % special case.)
523 % At run-time, environments start with this:
524 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
525 % initialize
526 \let\thisenv\empty
528 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
529 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
530 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
532 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
533 \def\checkenv#1{%
534 \def\temp{#1}%
535 \ifx\thisenv\temp
536 \else
537 \badenverr
541 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
542 \def\badenverr{%
543 \errhelp = \EMsimple
544 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
545 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
547 \def\inenvironment#1{%
548 \ifx#1\empty
549 outside of any environment%
550 \else
551 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
555 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
556 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
558 \parseargdef\end{%
559 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
560 \else
561 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
562 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
563 \csname E#1\endcsname
564 \endgroup
568 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
571 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
572 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
573 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
574 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
575 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
576 {\catcode`@ = 11
577 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
578 % if the definition is written into an index file.
579 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
580 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
583 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
584 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
586 % @* forces a line break.
587 \def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
589 % @/ allows a line break.
590 \let\/=\allowbreak
592 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
593 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
595 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
596 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
598 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
599 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
601 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
603 \def\onword{on}
604 \def\offword{off}
606 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
607 \def\temp{#1}%
608 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
609 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
610 \else
611 \errhelp = \EMsimple
612 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
613 \fi\fi
616 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
617 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
618 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
619 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
621 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
622 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
623 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
624 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
625 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
626 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
627 % the text is small, which looks bad.
629 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
630 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
631 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
632 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
633 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
634 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
636 \newbox\groupbox
637 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
639 \envdef\group{%
640 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
641 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
642 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
644 \startsavinginserts
646 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
647 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
648 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
649 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
650 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
651 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
652 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
653 \comment
656 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
657 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
658 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
659 % above. But it's pretty close.
660 \def\Egroup{%
661 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
662 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
663 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
664 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
665 \egroup % End the \vtop.
666 \addgroupbox
667 \prevdepth = \dimen1
668 \checkinserts
671 \def\addgroupbox{
672 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
673 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
674 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
675 \dimen2 = \txipageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
676 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
677 % group, force a page break.
678 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
679 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\txipageheight
680 \page
683 \box\groupbox
687 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
688 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
690 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
691 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
692 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
694 % @need space-in-mils
695 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
697 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
699 \parseargdef\need{%
700 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
701 % paragraph.
702 \par
704 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
705 \dimen0 = #1\mil
706 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
707 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
708 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
710 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
711 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
712 % And a page break here is fine.
713 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
715 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
716 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
717 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
718 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
719 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
721 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
722 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
723 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
724 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
725 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
726 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
727 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
728 \penalty9999
730 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
731 \kern -#1\mil
733 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
734 \nobreak
738 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
740 \let\br = \par
742 % @page forces the start of a new page.
744 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
746 % @exdent text....
747 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
749 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
750 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
751 \newskip\exdentamount
753 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
754 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
756 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
757 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
758 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
760 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
761 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
762 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
764 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
765 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
767 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
768 \nobreak
769 \kern-\strutdepth
770 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
771 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
772 \vss
773 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
774 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
775 \ifx#1l%
776 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
777 \else
778 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
780 \null
783 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
784 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
786 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
787 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
788 % else use TEXT for both).
790 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
791 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
792 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
793 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
794 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
795 \def\righttext{#2}%
796 \else
797 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
798 \def\righttext{#1}%
801 \ifodd\pageno
802 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
803 \else
804 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
806 \temp
809 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
811 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
812 \def\includezzz#1{%
813 \pushthisfilestack
814 \def\thisfile{#1}%
816 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
817 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
818 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
819 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
820 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
822 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
823 % definitions, etc.
824 \expandafter
825 }\temp
826 \popthisfilestack
828 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
829 \catcode`\\=\other
830 \catcode`~=\other
831 \catcode`^=\other
832 \catcode`_=\other
833 \catcode`|=\other
834 \catcode`<=\other
835 \catcode`>=\other
836 \catcode`+=\other
837 \catcode`-=\other
838 \catcode`\`=\other
839 \catcode`\'=\other
842 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
843 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
845 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
846 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
848 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
849 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
852 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
853 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
854 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
856 \def\thisfile{}
858 % @center line
859 % outputs that line, centered.
861 \parseargdef\center{%
862 \ifhmode
863 \let\centersub\centerH
864 \else
865 \let\centersub\centerV
867 \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
868 \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
870 \def\centerH#1{{%
871 \hfil\break
872 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
873 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
874 \line{#1}%
875 \break
878 \newcount\centerpenalty
879 \def\centerV#1{%
880 % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
881 % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
882 % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
883 % prevent a page break here.
884 \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
885 \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
886 \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
887 \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
890 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
892 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
894 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
895 % @c is the same as @comment
896 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
899 \def\c{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
900 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
901 \cxxx}
902 {\catcode`\^^M=\active \gdef\cxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
904 \let\comment\c
906 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
907 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
908 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
909 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
911 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
912 \def\noneword{none}
914 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
915 \def\temp{#1}%
916 \ifx\temp\asisword
917 \else
918 \ifx\temp\noneword
919 \defaultparindent = 0pt
920 \else
921 \defaultparindent = #1em
924 \parindent = \defaultparindent
927 % @exampleindent NCHARS
928 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
929 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
930 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
931 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
932 \def\temp{#1}%
933 \ifx\temp\asisword
934 \else
935 \ifx\temp\noneword
936 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
937 \else
938 \lispnarrowing = #1em
943 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
944 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
945 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
946 % paragraphs.
948 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
949 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
950 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
951 % By default, we suppress indentation.
953 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
954 \def\insertword{insert}
956 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
957 \def\temp{#1}%
958 \ifx\temp\noneword
959 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
960 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
961 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
962 \else
963 \errhelp = \EMsimple
964 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
965 \fi\fi
968 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
969 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
971 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
972 % paragraph.
974 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
975 \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
976 \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
977 \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
980 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
981 \global\let\indent = \ptexindent
982 \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent
983 \global\everypar = {}%
987 % @refill is a no-op.
988 \let\refill=\relax
990 % @setfilename INFO-FILENAME - ignored
991 \let\setfilename=\comment
993 % @bye.
994 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
997 \message{pdf,}
998 % adobe `portable' document format
999 \newcount\tempnum
1000 \newcount\lnkcount
1001 \newtoks\filename
1002 \newcount\filenamelength
1003 \newcount\pgn
1004 \newtoks\toksA
1005 \newtoks\toksB
1006 \newtoks\toksC
1007 \newtoks\toksD
1008 \newbox\boxA
1009 \newbox\boxB
1010 \newcount\countA
1011 \newif\ifpdf
1012 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1015 % For LuaTeX
1018 \newif\iftxiuseunicodedestname
1019 \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse % For pdfTeX etc.
1021 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
1022 \else
1023 % Use Unicode destination names
1024 \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
1025 % Escape PDF strings with converting UTF-16 from UTF-8
1026 \begingroup
1027 \catcode`\%=12
1028 \directlua{
1029 function UTF16oct(str)
1030 tex.sprint(string.char(0x5c) .. '376' .. string.char(0x5c) .. '377')
1031 for c in string.utfvalues(str) do
1032 if c < 0x10000 then
1033 tex.sprint(
1034 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1035 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1036 (c / 256), (c % 256)))
1037 else
1038 c = c - 0x10000
1039 local c_hi = c / 1024 + 0xd800
1040 local c_lo = c % 1024 + 0xdc00
1041 tex.sprint(
1042 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1043 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1044 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1045 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1046 (c_hi / 256), (c_hi % 256),
1047 (c_lo / 256), (c_lo % 256)))
1052 \endgroup
1053 \def\pdfescapestrutfsixteen#1{\directlua{UTF16oct('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
1054 % Escape PDF strings without converting
1055 \begingroup
1056 \directlua{
1057 function PDFescstr(str)
1058 for c in string.bytes(str) do
1059 if c <= 0x20 or c >= 0x80 or c == 0x28 or c == 0x29 or c == 0x5c then
1060 tex.sprint(
1061 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1063 else
1064 tex.sprint(string.char(c))
1069 \endgroup
1070 \def\pdfescapestring#1{\directlua{PDFescstr('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
1071 \ifnum\luatexversion>84
1072 % For LuaTeX >= 0.85
1073 \def\pdfdest{\pdfextension dest}
1074 \let\pdfoutput\outputmode
1075 \def\pdfliteral{\pdfextension literal}
1076 \def\pdfcatalog{\pdfextension catalog}
1077 \def\pdftexversion{\numexpr\pdffeedback version\relax}
1078 \let\pdfximage\saveimageresource
1079 \let\pdfrefximage\useimageresource
1080 \let\pdflastximage\lastsavedimageresourceindex
1081 \def\pdfendlink{\pdfextension endlink\relax}
1082 \def\pdfoutline{\pdfextension outline}
1083 \def\pdfstartlink{\pdfextension startlink}
1084 \def\pdffontattr{\pdfextension fontattr}
1085 \def\pdfobj{\pdfextension obj}
1086 \def\pdflastobj{\numexpr\pdffeedback lastobj\relax}
1087 \let\pdfpagewidth\pagewidth
1088 \let\pdfpageheight\pageheight
1089 \edef\pdfhorigin{\pdfvariable horigin}
1090 \edef\pdfvorigin{\pdfvariable vorigin}
1094 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1095 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
1096 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
1097 \else
1098 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1099 \else
1100 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1101 \else
1102 \pdftrue
1107 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1108 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1109 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1110 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1112 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
1113 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
1114 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1115 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
1116 % do this reliably, so we use it.
1118 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
1119 % which we \xdef.
1120 \def\txiescapepdf#1{%
1121 \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
1122 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
1123 % Many times it won't matter.
1124 \xdef#1{#1}%
1125 \else
1126 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
1127 % backslashes, and other special chars.
1128 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
1131 \def\txiescapepdfutfsixteen#1{%
1132 \ifx\pdfescapestrutfsixteen\thisisundefined
1133 % No UTF-16 converting macro available.
1134 \txiescapepdf{#1}%
1135 \else
1136 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestrutfsixteen{#1}}%
1140 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1141 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1142 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1143 output) for that.)}
1145 \ifpdf
1147 % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
1148 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
1149 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
1150 % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
1151 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
1152 % black by default, though.
1153 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1154 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1156 % rg sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1157 % RG sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1158 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
1160 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1161 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1162 \def\setcolor#1{%
1163 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1164 \domark
1165 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1168 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1169 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1170 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1171 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1173 \def\makefootline{%
1174 \baselineskip24pt
1175 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1178 \def\makeheadline{%
1179 \vbox to 0pt{%
1180 \vskip-22.5pt
1181 \line{%
1182 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1183 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1184 \getcolormarks
1185 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1186 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1188 \vss
1190 \nointerlineskip
1194 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1196 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1197 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1198 \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1199 \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1201 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1202 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1203 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1204 % bitmap.
1205 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1206 \begingroup
1207 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1208 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1209 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1210 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1211 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1212 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1213 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1214 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1215 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1217 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1219 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1221 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1223 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
1225 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1227 \closein 1
1228 \endgroup
1230 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1231 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1232 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1233 \immediate\pdfimage
1234 \else
1235 \immediate\pdfximage
1237 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
1238 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
1239 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1240 #1.\pdfimgext
1241 \else
1242 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1244 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1245 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1246 \fi}
1248 \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
1249 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1250 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1251 \indexnofonts
1252 \makevalueexpandable
1253 \turnoffactive
1254 \iftxiuseunicodedestname
1255 \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
1256 % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
1257 % LuaTeX with byte wise I/O converts Latin-1 characters to Unicode.
1258 \else
1259 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
1260 % Pass through Unicode characters.
1261 \else
1262 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1263 \passthroughcharsfalse
1266 \else
1267 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1268 \passthroughcharsfalse
1270 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1271 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1274 \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
1275 \indexnofonts
1276 \makevalueexpandable
1277 \turnoffactive
1278 \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
1279 % The PDF format can use an extended form of Latin-1 in bookmark
1280 % strings. See Appendix D of the PDF Reference, Sixth Edition, for
1281 % the "PDFDocEncoding".
1282 \passthroughcharstrue
1283 % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
1284 % LuaTeX: Convert to Unicode
1285 % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
1286 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1287 \else
1288 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
1289 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
1290 % For pdfTeX with UTF-8.
1291 % TODO: the PDF format can use UTF-16 in bookmark strings,
1292 % but the code for this isn't done yet.
1293 % Use ASCII approximations.
1294 \passthroughcharsfalse
1295 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1296 \else
1297 % For LuaTeX with UTF-8.
1298 % Pass through Unicode characters for title texts.
1299 \passthroughcharstrue
1300 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1302 \else
1303 % For non-Latin-1 or non-UTF-8 encodings.
1304 % Use ASCII approximations.
1305 \passthroughcharsfalse
1306 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1309 % LuaTeX: Convert to UTF-16
1310 % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
1311 \txiescapepdfutfsixteen\pdfoutlinetext
1314 \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
1315 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
1316 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1319 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1320 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1322 % by default, use black for everything.
1323 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1324 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1325 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1327 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1328 % come from Petr Olsak
1329 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1330 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1331 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1332 \advance\tempnum by 1
1333 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1335 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1336 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1337 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1338 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1339 % #4 is the page number
1341 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1342 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1343 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1344 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1345 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1346 \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
1347 \setpdfdestname{#3}
1348 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
1349 \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
1352 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1355 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1356 \begingroup
1357 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1358 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1359 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1360 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1361 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1362 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1364 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1365 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1366 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1367 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1369 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1370 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1371 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1373 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1374 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1376 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1377 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1378 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1380 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1381 % al. a second time, below.
1382 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1383 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1384 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1385 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1386 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1387 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1388 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1389 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1390 \readdatafile{toc}%
1392 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1393 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1394 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1396 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1397 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1398 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1399 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1400 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1401 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1402 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1403 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1404 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1406 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1407 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1408 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1409 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1410 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1412 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1413 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
1414 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
1415 % we use for the index sort strings.
1417 \indexnofonts
1418 \setupdatafile
1419 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1420 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1421 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1422 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1423 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1424 \input \tocreadfilename
1425 \endgroup
1427 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1428 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1429 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1430 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1433 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1434 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1435 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1436 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1437 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1439 \nextsp}
1440 \def\getfilename#1{%
1441 \filenamelength=0
1442 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1443 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1444 \edef\temp{#1}%
1445 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1447 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1448 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1449 \else
1450 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1452 % make a live url in pdf output.
1453 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1454 \begingroup
1455 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1456 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1457 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1458 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1460 \normalturnoffactive
1461 \def\@{@}%
1462 \let\/=\empty
1463 \makevalueexpandable
1464 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1465 % special-casing \var here?
1466 \def\var##1{##1}%
1468 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1469 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1470 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1471 \endgroup}
1472 % \pdfgettoks - Surround page numbers in #1 with @pdflink. #1 may
1473 % be a simple number, or a list of numbers in the case of an index
1474 % entry.
1475 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1476 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1477 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1478 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1479 \def\maketoks{%
1480 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1481 \ifx\first0\adn0
1482 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1483 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1484 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1485 \else
1486 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1487 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1488 \let\next=\maketoks
1489 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1490 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1492 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1493 \next}
1494 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1495 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1496 \def\pdflink#1{%
1497 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1498 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1499 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1500 \else
1501 % non-pdf mode
1502 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1503 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1504 \let\endlink = \relax
1505 \let\setcolor = \gobble
1506 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
1507 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1508 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1511 % For XeTeX
1513 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
1514 \else
1516 % XeTeX version check
1518 \ifnum\strcmp{\the\XeTeXversion\XeTeXrevision}{0.99996}>-1
1519 % TeX Live 2016 contains XeTeX 0.99996 and xdvipdfmx 20160307.
1520 % It can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special (from TeX Live SVN r40941).
1521 % For avoiding PDF destination name replacement, we use this special
1522 % instead of xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
1523 \special{dvipdfmx:config C 0x0010}
1524 % XeTeX 0.99995+ comes with xdvipdfmx 20160307+.
1525 % It can handle Unicode destination names for PDF.
1526 \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
1527 \else
1528 % XeTeX < 0.99996 (TeX Live < 2016) cannot use the
1529 % `dvipdfmx:config' special.
1530 % So for avoiding PDF destination name replacement,
1531 % xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010' is necessary.
1533 % XeTeX < 0.99995 can not handle Unicode destination names for PDF
1534 % because xdvipdfmx 20150315 has a UTF-16 conversion issue.
1535 % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
1536 \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse
1539 % Color support
1541 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1542 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1544 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\special{pdf:scolor [#1]}}
1546 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1547 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1548 \def\setcolor#1{%
1549 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1550 \domark
1551 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1554 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1555 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1556 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1557 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1559 \def\makefootline{%
1560 \baselineskip24pt
1561 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1564 \def\makeheadline{%
1565 \vbox to 0pt{%
1566 \vskip-22.5pt
1567 \line{%
1568 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1569 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1570 \getcolormarks
1571 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1572 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1574 \vss
1576 \nointerlineskip
1579 % PDF outline support
1581 % Emulate pdfTeX primitive
1582 \def\pdfdest name#1 xyz{%
1583 \special{pdf:dest (#1) [@thispage /XYZ @xpos @ypos null]}%
1586 \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
1587 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1588 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1589 \indexnofonts
1590 \makevalueexpandable
1591 \turnoffactive
1592 \iftxiuseunicodedestname
1593 % Pass through Unicode characters.
1594 \else
1595 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1596 \passthroughcharsfalse
1598 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1599 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1602 \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
1603 \turnoffactive
1604 % Always use Unicode characters in title texts.
1605 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1606 % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts to UTF-16.
1607 % So we do not convert.
1608 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
1611 \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
1612 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
1613 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1616 % by default, use black for everything.
1617 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1618 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1619 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1621 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1622 \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
1623 \setpdfdestname{#3}
1624 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
1625 \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
1628 \special{pdf:out [-] #2 << /Title (\pdfoutlinetext) /A
1629 << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >> }%
1632 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1633 \begingroup
1635 % For XeTeX, counts of subentries are not necessary.
1636 % Therefore, we read toc only once.
1638 % We use node names as destinations.
1639 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1640 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1641 \dopdfoutline{##1}{1}{##3}{##4}}%
1642 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1643 \dopdfoutline{##1}{2}{##3}{##4}}%
1644 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1645 \dopdfoutline{##1}{3}{##3}{##4}}%
1646 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1647 \dopdfoutline{##1}{4}{##3}{##4}}%
1649 \let\appentry\numchapentry%
1650 \let\appsecentry\numsecentry%
1651 \let\appsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
1652 \let\appsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
1653 \let\unnchapentry\numchapentry%
1654 \let\unnsecentry\numsecentry%
1655 \let\unnsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
1656 \let\unnsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
1658 % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts strings to UTF-16.
1659 % Therefore, the encoding and the language may not be considered.
1661 \indexnofonts
1662 \setupdatafile
1663 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1664 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1665 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1666 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1667 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1668 \input \tocreadfilename
1669 \endgroup
1671 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1672 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1673 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1674 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1677 \special{pdf:docview << /PageMode /UseOutlines >> }
1678 % ``\special{pdf:tounicode ...}'' is not necessary
1679 % because xdvipdfmx converts strings from UTF-8 to UTF-16 without it.
1680 % However, due to a UTF-16 conversion issue of xdvipdfmx 20150315,
1681 % ``\special{pdf:dest ...}'' cannot handle non-ASCII strings.
1682 % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
1684 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1685 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1686 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1687 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1688 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1690 \nextsp}
1691 \def\getfilename#1{%
1692 \filenamelength=0
1693 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1694 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1695 \edef\temp{#1}%
1696 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1698 % make a live url in pdf output.
1699 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1700 \begingroup
1701 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1702 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1703 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1704 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1706 \normalturnoffactive
1707 \def\@{@}%
1708 \let\/=\empty
1709 \makevalueexpandable
1710 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1711 % special-casing \var here?
1712 \def\var##1{##1}%
1714 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1715 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
1716 /Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >> >>}%
1717 \endgroup}
1718 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\special{pdf:eann}}
1719 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1720 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1721 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1722 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1723 \def\maketoks{%
1724 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1725 \ifx\first0\adn0
1726 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1727 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1728 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1729 \else
1730 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1731 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1732 \let\next=\maketoks
1733 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1734 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1736 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1737 \next}
1738 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1739 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1740 \def\pdflink#1{%
1741 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
1742 /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A << /S /GoTo /D (#1) >> >>}%
1743 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1744 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1747 % @image support
1749 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1750 \def\doxeteximage#1#2#3{%
1751 \def\xeteximagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1752 \def\xeteximageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1754 % XeTeX (and the PDF format) supports .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1755 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1756 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1757 % bitmap.
1758 \let\xeteximgext=\empty
1759 \begingroup
1760 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1761 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1762 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1763 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1764 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1765 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1766 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for XeTeX}%
1767 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{JPG}%
1769 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpeg}%
1771 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpg}%
1773 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{png}%
1775 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{PDF}%
1777 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{pdf}%
1779 \closein 1
1780 \endgroup
1782 \def\xetexpdfext{pdf}%
1783 \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
1784 \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1785 \else
1786 \def\xetexpdfext{PDF}%
1787 \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
1788 \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1789 \else
1790 \XeTeXpicfile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1793 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \xeteximagewidth \fi
1794 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \xeteximageheight \fi \relax
1800 \message{fonts,}
1802 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1803 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1804 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1806 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1807 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1808 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1810 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1811 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1813 \newdimen\textleading
1814 \def\setleading#1{%
1815 \dimen0 = #1\relax
1816 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
1817 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1818 \normalbaselines
1819 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1820 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1821 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1825 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1827 % do nothing with this by default.
1828 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1829 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1830 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1832 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1833 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1834 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1835 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
1836 \begingroup
1837 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1838 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1839 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1840 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1841 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1842 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1843 %%Version: 1.000
1844 %%EndComments
1845 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1846 12 dict begin
1847 begincmap
1848 /CIDSystemInfo
1849 << /Registry (TeX)
1850 /Ordering (OT1)
1851 /Supplement 0
1852 >> def
1853 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1854 /CMapType 2 def
1855 1 begincodespacerange
1856 <00> <7F>
1857 endcodespacerange
1858 8 beginbfrange
1859 <00> <01> <0393>
1860 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1861 <23> <26> <0023>
1862 <28> <3B> <0028>
1863 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1864 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1865 <61> <7A> <0061>
1866 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1867 endbfrange
1868 40 beginbfchar
1869 <02> <0398>
1870 <03> <039B>
1871 <04> <039E>
1872 <05> <03A0>
1873 <06> <03A3>
1874 <07> <03D2>
1875 <08> <03A6>
1876 <0B> <00660066>
1877 <0C> <00660069>
1878 <0D> <0066006C>
1879 <0E> <006600660069>
1880 <0F> <00660066006C>
1881 <10> <0131>
1882 <11> <0237>
1883 <12> <0060>
1884 <13> <00B4>
1885 <14> <02C7>
1886 <15> <02D8>
1887 <16> <00AF>
1888 <17> <02DA>
1889 <18> <00B8>
1890 <19> <00DF>
1891 <1A> <00E6>
1892 <1B> <0153>
1893 <1C> <00F8>
1894 <1D> <00C6>
1895 <1E> <0152>
1896 <1F> <00D8>
1897 <21> <0021>
1898 <22> <201D>
1899 <27> <2019>
1900 <3C> <00A1>
1901 <3D> <003D>
1902 <3E> <00BF>
1903 <5C> <201C>
1904 <5F> <02D9>
1905 <60> <2018>
1906 <7D> <02DD>
1907 <7E> <007E>
1908 <7F> <00A8>
1909 endbfchar
1910 endcmap
1911 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1914 %%EndResource
1915 %%EOF
1916 }\endgroup
1917 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1918 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1921 % \cmapOT1IT
1922 \begingroup
1923 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1924 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1925 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1926 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1927 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1928 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1929 %%Version: 1.000
1930 %%EndComments
1931 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1932 12 dict begin
1933 begincmap
1934 /CIDSystemInfo
1935 << /Registry (TeX)
1936 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1937 /Supplement 0
1938 >> def
1939 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
1940 /CMapType 2 def
1941 1 begincodespacerange
1942 <00> <7F>
1943 endcodespacerange
1944 8 beginbfrange
1945 <00> <01> <0393>
1946 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1947 <25> <26> <0025>
1948 <28> <3B> <0028>
1949 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1950 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1951 <61> <7A> <0061>
1952 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1953 endbfrange
1954 42 beginbfchar
1955 <02> <0398>
1956 <03> <039B>
1957 <04> <039E>
1958 <05> <03A0>
1959 <06> <03A3>
1960 <07> <03D2>
1961 <08> <03A6>
1962 <0B> <00660066>
1963 <0C> <00660069>
1964 <0D> <0066006C>
1965 <0E> <006600660069>
1966 <0F> <00660066006C>
1967 <10> <0131>
1968 <11> <0237>
1969 <12> <0060>
1970 <13> <00B4>
1971 <14> <02C7>
1972 <15> <02D8>
1973 <16> <00AF>
1974 <17> <02DA>
1975 <18> <00B8>
1976 <19> <00DF>
1977 <1A> <00E6>
1978 <1B> <0153>
1979 <1C> <00F8>
1980 <1D> <00C6>
1981 <1E> <0152>
1982 <1F> <00D8>
1983 <21> <0021>
1984 <22> <201D>
1985 <23> <0023>
1986 <24> <00A3>
1987 <27> <2019>
1988 <3C> <00A1>
1989 <3D> <003D>
1990 <3E> <00BF>
1991 <5C> <201C>
1992 <5F> <02D9>
1993 <60> <2018>
1994 <7D> <02DD>
1995 <7E> <007E>
1996 <7F> <00A8>
1997 endbfchar
1998 endcmap
1999 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
2002 %%EndResource
2003 %%EOF
2004 }\endgroup
2005 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
2006 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
2009 % \cmapOT1TT
2010 \begingroup
2011 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
2012 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
2013 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
2014 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
2015 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
2016 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
2017 %%Version: 1.000
2018 %%EndComments
2019 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
2020 12 dict begin
2021 begincmap
2022 /CIDSystemInfo
2023 << /Registry (TeX)
2024 /Ordering (OT1TT)
2025 /Supplement 0
2026 >> def
2027 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
2028 /CMapType 2 def
2029 1 begincodespacerange
2030 <00> <7F>
2031 endcodespacerange
2032 5 beginbfrange
2033 <00> <01> <0393>
2034 <09> <0A> <03A8>
2035 <21> <26> <0021>
2036 <28> <5F> <0028>
2037 <61> <7E> <0061>
2038 endbfrange
2039 32 beginbfchar
2040 <02> <0398>
2041 <03> <039B>
2042 <04> <039E>
2043 <05> <03A0>
2044 <06> <03A3>
2045 <07> <03D2>
2046 <08> <03A6>
2047 <0B> <2191>
2048 <0C> <2193>
2049 <0D> <0027>
2050 <0E> <00A1>
2051 <0F> <00BF>
2052 <10> <0131>
2053 <11> <0237>
2054 <12> <0060>
2055 <13> <00B4>
2056 <14> <02C7>
2057 <15> <02D8>
2058 <16> <00AF>
2059 <17> <02DA>
2060 <18> <00B8>
2061 <19> <00DF>
2062 <1A> <00E6>
2063 <1B> <0153>
2064 <1C> <00F8>
2065 <1D> <00C6>
2066 <1E> <0152>
2067 <1F> <00D8>
2068 <20> <2423>
2069 <27> <2019>
2070 <60> <2018>
2071 <7F> <00A8>
2072 endbfchar
2073 endcmap
2074 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
2077 %%EndResource
2078 %%EOF
2079 }\endgroup
2080 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
2081 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
2083 \fi\fi
2086 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
2087 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
2088 % encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
2089 % Example:
2090 % #1 = \textrm
2091 % #2 = \rmshape
2092 % #3 = 10
2093 % #4 = \mainmagstep
2094 % #5 = OT1
2096 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
2097 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
2098 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
2100 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
2101 \let\cmap\gobble
2103 % (end of cmaps)
2105 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
2106 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
2107 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
2108 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
2109 \def\fontprefix{cm}
2111 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
2112 \def\rmshape{r}
2113 \def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold
2114 \def\bfshape{b}
2115 \def\bxshape{bx}
2116 \def\ttshape{tt}
2117 \def\ttbshape{tt}
2118 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
2119 \def\itshape{ti}
2120 \def\itbshape{bxti}
2121 \def\slshape{sl}
2122 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
2123 \def\sfshape{ss}
2124 \def\sfbshape{ss}
2125 \def\scshape{csc}
2126 \def\scbshape{csc}
2128 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
2130 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
2131 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
2132 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
2133 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
2134 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2135 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2136 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2137 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2138 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2139 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2140 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2141 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2142 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2143 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2144 \def\textecsize{1095}
2146 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2147 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2148 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2149 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2150 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2151 \def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
2152 \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \let\slfont=\defsl \bf}
2154 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2155 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2156 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2157 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2158 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2159 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2160 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2161 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2162 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2163 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2164 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2165 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2166 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2168 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2169 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2170 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2171 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2172 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2173 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2174 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2175 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2176 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2177 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2178 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2179 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2180 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2182 % Fonts for math mode superscripts (7pt).
2183 \def\sevennominalsize{7pt}
2184 \setfont\sevenrm\rmshape{7}{1000}{OT1}
2185 \setfont\seventt\ttshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
2186 \setfont\sevenbf\bfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2187 \setfont\sevenit\itshape{7}{1000}{OT1IT}
2188 \setfont\sevensl\slshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2189 \setfont\sevensf\sfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2190 \setfont\sevensc\scshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2191 \setfont\seventtsl\ttslshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
2192 \font\seveni=cmmi7
2193 \font\sevensy=cmsy7
2194 \def\sevenecsize{0700}
2196 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2197 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2198 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2199 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2200 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2201 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2202 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2203 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2204 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2205 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2206 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2207 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2208 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2210 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
2211 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
2212 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2213 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
2214 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2215 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2216 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2217 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
2218 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
2219 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2220 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
2221 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
2222 \def\chapecsize{1728}
2224 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
2225 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
2226 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2227 \setfont\secrmnotbold\rmshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2228 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2229 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2230 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2231 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2232 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2233 \let\secbf\secrm
2234 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2235 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2236 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2237 \def\sececsize{1440}
2239 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
2240 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
2241 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2242 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
2243 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2244 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2245 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
2246 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2247 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2248 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2249 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
2250 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
2251 \def\ssececsize{1200}
2253 % Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (10pt).
2254 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
2255 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2256 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2257 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2258 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2259 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2260 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2261 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2262 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2263 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
2264 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
2265 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
2267 \textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
2268 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2270 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
2273 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
2274 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
2275 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
2276 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
2278 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
2279 % Text fonts (10pt).
2280 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
2281 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
2282 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2283 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2284 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2285 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2286 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2287 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2288 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2289 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2290 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2291 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2292 \def\textecsize{1000}
2294 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2295 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2296 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2297 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2298 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2299 \def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
2300 \let\slfont=\defsl \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \bf}
2302 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2303 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2304 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2305 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2306 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2307 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2308 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2309 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2310 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2311 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2312 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2313 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2314 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2316 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2317 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2318 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2319 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2320 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2321 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2322 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2323 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2324 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2325 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2326 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2327 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2328 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2330 % Fonts for math mode superscripts (7pt).
2331 \def\sevennominalsize{7pt}
2332 \setfont\sevenrm\rmshape{7}{1000}{OT1}
2333 \setfont\seventt\ttshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
2334 \setfont\sevenbf\bfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2335 \setfont\sevenit\itshape{7}{1000}{OT1IT}
2336 \setfont\sevensl\slshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2337 \setfont\sevensf\sfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2338 \setfont\sevensc\scshape{10}{700}{OT1}
2339 \setfont\seventtsl\ttslshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
2340 \font\seveni=cmmi7
2341 \font\sevensy=cmsy7
2342 \def\sevenecsize{0700}
2344 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2345 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2346 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2347 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2348 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2349 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2350 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2351 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2352 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2353 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2354 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2355 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2356 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2358 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2359 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2360 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2361 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2362 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2363 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2364 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2365 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2366 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2367 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2368 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2369 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2370 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2372 % Section fonts (12pt).
2373 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2374 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2375 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2376 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2377 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2378 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2379 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2380 \let\secbf\secrm
2381 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2382 \font\seci=cmmi12
2383 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2384 \def\sececsize{1200}
2386 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2387 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2388 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2389 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2390 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2391 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2392 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2393 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2394 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2395 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2396 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2397 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2398 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2400 % Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (9pt).
2401 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2402 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2403 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2404 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2405 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2406 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2407 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2408 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2409 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2410 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2411 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2412 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2414 \divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs
2415 \textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM
2416 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2418 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
2420 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2421 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2422 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2423 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2424 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2427 % We provide the user-level command
2428 % @fonttextsize 10
2429 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2431 \def\xiword{11}
2432 \def\xword{10}
2433 \def\xwordpt{10pt}
2435 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2436 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2437 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2439 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2440 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2442 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2443 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2444 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2445 \else
2446 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2447 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2448 \fi\fi
2449 \endgroup
2453 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
2454 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
2455 % italics, not bold italics.
2457 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
2458 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
2459 \csname #1font\endcsname % change the current font
2462 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
2463 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
2464 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
2465 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
2466 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
2468 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
2469 % So we set up a \sf.
2470 \newfam\sffam
2471 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
2473 % We don't need math for this font style.
2474 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
2477 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2478 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families.
2479 % We don't bother to reset \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
2481 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2482 \textfont0=\rmfont \textfont1=\ifont \textfont2=\syfont
2483 \textfont\itfam=\itfont \textfont\slfam=\slfont \textfont\bffam=\bffont
2484 \textfont\ttfam=\ttfont \textfont\sffam=\sffont
2486 % Fonts for superscript. Note that the 7pt fonts are used regardless
2487 % of the current font size.
2488 \scriptfont0=\sevenrm \scriptfont1=\seveni \scriptfont2=\sevensy
2489 \scriptfont\itfam=\sevenit \scriptfont\slfam=\sevensl
2490 \scriptfont\bffam=\sevenbf \scriptfont\ttfam=\seventt
2491 \scriptfont\sffam=\sevensf
2496 % The font-changing commands (all called \...fonts) redefine the meanings
2497 % of \STYLEfont, instead of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs
2498 % to also set the current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm)
2499 % commands hardwire \STYLEfont to set the current font.
2501 % The fonts used for \ifont are for "math italics" (\itfont is for italics
2502 % in regular text). \syfont is also used in math mode only.
2504 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2505 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used
2506 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2508 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2511 \def\assignfonts#1{%
2512 \expandafter\let\expandafter\rmfont\csname #1rm\endcsname
2513 \expandafter\let\expandafter\itfont\csname #1it\endcsname
2514 \expandafter\let\expandafter\slfont\csname #1sl\endcsname
2515 \expandafter\let\expandafter\bffont\csname #1bf\endcsname
2516 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttfont\csname #1tt\endcsname
2517 \expandafter\let\expandafter\smallcaps\csname #1sc\endcsname
2518 \expandafter\let\expandafter\sffont \csname #1sf\endcsname
2519 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ifont \csname #1i\endcsname
2520 \expandafter\let\expandafter\syfont \csname #1sy\endcsname
2521 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttslfont\csname #1ttsl\endcsname
2524 \newif\ifrmisbold
2526 % Select smaller font size with the current style. Used to change font size
2527 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms. If we are using bold fonts for
2528 % normal roman text, also use bold fonts for roman text in the smaller size.
2529 \def\switchtolllsize{%
2530 \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lllsize}%
2531 \ifrmisbold
2532 \let\rmfont\bffont
2534 \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
2537 \def\switchtolsize{%
2538 \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lsize}%
2539 \ifrmisbold
2540 \let\rmfont\bffont
2542 \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
2545 \def\definefontsetatsize#1#2#3#4#5{%
2546 \expandafter\def\csname #1fonts\endcsname{%
2547 \def\curfontsize{#1}%
2548 \def\lsize{#2}\def\lllsize{#3}%
2549 \csname rmisbold#5\endcsname
2550 \assignfonts{#1}%
2551 \resetmathfonts
2552 \setleading{#4}%
2555 \definefontsetatsize{text} {reduced}{smaller}{\textleading}{false}
2556 \definefontsetatsize{title} {chap} {subsec} {27pt} {true}
2557 \definefontsetatsize{chap} {sec} {text} {19pt} {true}
2558 \definefontsetatsize{sec} {subsec} {reduced}{17pt} {true}
2559 \definefontsetatsize{ssec} {text} {small} {15pt} {true}
2560 \definefontsetatsize{reduced}{small} {smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
2561 \definefontsetatsize{small} {smaller}{smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
2562 \definefontsetatsize{smaller}{smaller}{smaller}{9.5pt} {false}
2564 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
2565 \let\subsecfonts = \ssecfonts
2566 \let\subsubsecfonts = \ssecfonts
2568 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2569 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2570 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2572 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2573 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2575 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2576 % can fit this many characters:
2577 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2578 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2579 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2580 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2581 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2583 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2584 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2585 % --karl, 24jan03.
2587 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2589 \definetextfontsizexi
2592 \message{markup,}
2594 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2595 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2596 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2597 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2599 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2601 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2602 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2603 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2604 % style.
2606 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2608 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2609 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2610 \markupstylesetup
2613 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2615 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2616 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2617 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2618 \def#1%
2621 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2622 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2623 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2624 \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2625 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2628 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2629 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2630 \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2631 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2635 \catcode`\'=\active
2636 \catcode`\`=\active
2638 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
2639 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
2641 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
2642 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
2645 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2646 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2648 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2649 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2651 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
2652 \let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
2654 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
2655 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
2657 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2658 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2660 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2661 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2663 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
2664 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
2665 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
2666 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
2667 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
2669 \def\codequoteright{%
2670 \ifmonospace
2671 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2672 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2674 \else \char'15 \fi
2675 \else \char'15 \fi
2676 \else
2681 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2682 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2683 % the code environments to do likewise.
2685 \def\codequoteleft{%
2686 \ifmonospace
2687 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2688 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2689 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2690 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2691 \relax`%
2692 \else \char'22 \fi
2693 \else \char'22 \fi
2694 \else
2695 \relax`%
2699 % Commands to set the quote options.
2701 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
2702 \def\temp{#1}%
2703 \ifx\temp\onword
2704 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2705 = t%
2706 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2707 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2708 = \relax
2709 \else
2710 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2711 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2712 \fi\fi
2715 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
2716 \def\temp{#1}%
2717 \ifx\temp\onword
2718 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2719 = t%
2720 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2721 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2722 = \relax
2723 \else
2724 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2725 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2726 \fi\fi
2729 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2730 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2732 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2733 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2735 % Font commands.
2737 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
2738 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
2739 % and 2) do not add an italic correction.
2740 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
2741 \ifusingtt
2742 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
2743 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
2744 \next
2746 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
2747 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
2749 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
2750 % character) is such as not to need one.
2751 \def\smartitaliccorrection{%
2752 \ifx\next,%
2753 \else\ifx\next-%
2754 \else\ifx\next.%
2755 \else\ifx\next\.%
2756 \else\ifx\next\comma%
2757 \else\ptexslash
2758 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
2759 \aftersmartic
2762 % Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
2763 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
2765 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2766 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2767 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
2769 \def\aftersmartic{}
2770 \def\var#1{%
2771 \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
2772 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
2773 \smartslanted{#1}%
2776 \let\i=\smartitalic
2777 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2778 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2779 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2781 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2782 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2783 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2784 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2786 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2787 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2788 \let\strong=\b
2790 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2791 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2793 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2794 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2795 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2797 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2798 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2800 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2801 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2802 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2804 \catcode`@=11
2805 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2806 \sfcode`\.=\@m \sfcode`\?=\@m \sfcode`\!=\@m
2807 \sfcode`\:=\@m \sfcode`\;=\@m \sfcode`\,=\@m
2808 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2810 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2811 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2812 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2813 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2815 \catcode`@=\other
2816 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2818 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2819 \def\t#1{%
2820 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2821 \null
2824 % @samp.
2825 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2827 % @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
2828 \let\indicateurl=\samp
2830 % @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
2831 % size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
2832 % This is a subroutine for that.
2833 \def\tclose#1{%
2835 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2836 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2838 % Switch to typewriter.
2841 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2842 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2844 % Turn off hyphenation.
2845 \nohyphenation
2847 \rawbackslash
2848 \plainfrenchspacing
2851 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
2854 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2855 % (But see \codedashfinish below.)
2856 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2857 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2859 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2860 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2861 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2862 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
2864 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2865 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2866 \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
2868 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2869 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2870 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2871 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2872 \ifallowcodebreaks
2873 \let-\codedash
2874 \let_\codeunder
2875 \else
2876 \let-\normaldash
2877 \let_\realunder
2879 % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
2880 % after the hyphen.
2881 \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
2883 \codex
2886 \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
2887 \gdef\codedashfinish{%
2888 \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
2890 % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
2891 % (a) the next character is a -, or
2892 % (b) the preceding character is a -.
2893 % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
2894 % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
2895 \ifx\next\codedash \else
2896 \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
2897 \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
2899 % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
2900 % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
2901 \global\let\codedashprev= \next
2904 \def\normaldash{-}
2906 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2908 \def\codeunder{%
2909 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2910 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2911 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2912 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2913 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2914 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2915 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2916 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2917 {\_}%
2920 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2921 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
2922 % @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
2923 % and _ on and off.
2925 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2927 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2928 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2930 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2931 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2932 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2933 \allowcodebreakstrue
2934 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2935 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2936 \else
2937 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2938 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
2939 \fi\fi
2942 % For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
2943 % so use \code rather than \samp.
2944 \let\command=\code
2945 \let\env=\code
2946 \let\file=\code
2947 \let\option=\code
2949 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
2950 % (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
2951 % an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
2952 % addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
2954 % TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
2955 % arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
2956 \newif\ifurefurlonlylink
2958 % The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
2959 % places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
2960 % didn't support automatic breaking.)
2961 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
2962 \let\uref=\urefbreak
2964 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
2965 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
2966 \unsepspaces
2967 \pdfurl{#1}%
2968 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2969 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2970 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2971 \else
2972 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
2973 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2974 \ifpdf
2975 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
2976 \ifurefurlonlylink
2977 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
2978 \unhbox0
2979 \else
2980 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
2981 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
2982 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
2984 \else
2985 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
2986 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
2987 \else
2988 % For XeTeX
2989 \ifurefurlonlylink
2990 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
2991 \unhbox0
2992 \else
2993 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
2994 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
2995 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
2999 \else
3000 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
3003 \endlink
3004 \endgroup}
3006 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
3007 \def\urefcatcodes{%
3008 \catcode`\&=\active \catcode`\.=\active
3009 \catcode`\#=\active \catcode`\?=\active
3010 \catcode`\/=\active
3013 \urefcatcodes
3015 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
3016 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
3017 \urefcatcodes
3018 \let&\urefcodeamp
3019 \let.\urefcodedot
3020 \let#\urefcodehash
3021 \let?\urefcodequest
3022 \let/\urefcodeslash
3023 \codex
3026 % By default, they are just regular characters.
3027 \global\def&{\normalamp}
3028 \global\def.{\normaldot}
3029 \global\def#{\normalhash}
3030 \global\def?{\normalquest}
3031 \global\def/{\normalslash}
3034 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
3035 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
3036 % cmtt at least, especially for dots.
3037 \def\urefprestretchamount{.13em}
3038 \def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em}
3039 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
3040 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
3042 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch}
3043 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch}
3044 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch}
3045 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch}
3046 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
3048 \catcode`\/=\active
3049 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
3050 \urefprestretch \slashChar
3051 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
3052 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
3053 \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi
3057 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
3058 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
3059 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
3061 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
3062 \def\txiarg{#1}%
3063 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
3064 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
3065 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
3066 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
3067 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
3068 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
3069 \else
3070 \errhelp = \EMsimple
3071 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
3072 \fi\fi\fi
3074 \def\wordafter{after}
3075 \def\wordbefore{before}
3076 \def\wordnone{none}
3078 \urefbreakstyle after
3080 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
3082 \let\url=\uref
3084 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
3085 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
3087 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
3088 \ifpdf
3089 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
3090 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
3091 \unsepspaces
3092 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
3093 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
3094 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
3095 \endlink
3096 \endgroup}
3097 \else
3098 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
3099 \let\email=\uref
3100 \else
3101 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
3102 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
3103 \unsepspaces
3104 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
3105 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
3106 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
3107 \endlink
3108 \endgroup}
3112 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
3113 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
3114 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
3115 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
3116 \def\txiarg{#1}%
3117 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
3118 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
3119 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
3120 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
3121 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
3122 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
3123 \else
3124 \errhelp = \EMsimple
3125 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
3126 \fi\fi\fi
3128 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
3129 \def\wordexample{example}
3130 \def\wordcode{code}
3132 % Default is `distinct'.
3133 \kbdinputstyle distinct
3135 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
3136 % then @kbd has no effect.
3137 \def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
3139 \def\xkey{\key}
3140 \def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
3141 \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
3142 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
3143 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
3144 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
3147 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
3148 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
3149 %\font\keysy=cmsy9
3150 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
3151 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
3152 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
3153 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
3154 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
3155 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
3157 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
3158 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
3159 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
3161 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
3162 \nohyphenation
3163 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
3164 #1}\null}
3166 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
3167 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
3169 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
3170 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
3171 \def\click{\arrow}
3173 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
3174 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
3176 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
3178 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
3179 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
3180 % all-uppercase.
3182 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
3183 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
3184 {\switchtolsize #1}%
3185 \def\temp{#2}%
3186 \ifx\temp\empty \else
3187 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
3189 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
3192 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
3193 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
3195 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
3196 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
3197 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
3198 \def\temp{#2}%
3199 \ifx\temp\empty \else
3200 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
3202 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
3205 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
3207 \def\asis#1{#1}
3209 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
3211 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
3212 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
3213 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
3214 % which is what @var uses.
3216 \catcode`\_ = \active
3217 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
3218 \catcode`\_=\active
3219 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
3222 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
3223 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
3224 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
3226 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
3227 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
3229 \def\math{%
3230 \ifmmode\else % only go into math if not in math mode already
3231 \tex
3232 \mathunderscore
3233 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
3234 \mathactive
3235 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
3236 \let\"=\ddot
3237 \let\'=\acute
3238 \let\==\bar
3239 \let\^=\hat
3240 \let\`=\grave
3241 \let\u=\breve
3242 \let\v=\check
3243 \let\~=\tilde
3244 \let\dotaccent=\dot
3245 % have to provide another name for sup operator
3246 \let\mathopsup=\sup
3247 $\expandafter\finishmath\fi
3249 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
3251 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
3252 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
3253 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
3256 \catcode`^ = \active
3257 \catcode`< = \active
3258 \catcode`> = \active
3259 \catcode`+ = \active
3260 \catcode`' = \active
3261 \gdef\mathactive{%
3262 \let^ = \ptexhat
3263 \let< = \ptexless
3264 \let> = \ptexgtr
3265 \let+ = \ptexplus
3266 \let' = \ptexquoteright
3270 % for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
3271 % If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
3272 % into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the
3273 % one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
3274 % fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
3276 \def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
3277 \def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
3279 \def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
3280 \def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
3282 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
3283 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
3284 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
3286 \def\outfmtnametex{tex}
3288 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
3289 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
3290 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
3291 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
3294 % @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
3295 % FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
3296 \long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
3297 \long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
3298 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
3299 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
3302 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
3303 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
3304 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
3305 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
3306 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
3307 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
3308 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
3310 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
3311 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
3312 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
3313 \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
3314 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
3315 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
3318 % @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
3320 \long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
3321 \long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
3322 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
3323 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
3324 \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
3327 % @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
3329 \long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
3330 \long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
3331 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
3332 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
3336 \message{glyphs,}
3337 % and logos.
3339 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
3340 \def\@{\char64 }
3341 \let\atchar=\@
3343 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
3344 \def\lbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char123\else\ensuremath\lbrace\fi}}
3345 \def\rbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char125\else\ensuremath\rbrace\fi}}
3346 \let\{=\lbracechar
3347 \let\}=\rbracechar
3349 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
3350 \let\comma = ,
3352 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
3353 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
3354 \let\, = \ptexc
3355 \let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
3356 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
3357 \let\tieaccent = \ptext
3358 \let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
3359 \let\udotaccent = \d
3361 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
3362 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
3363 \def\questiondown{?`}
3364 \def\exclamdown{!`}
3365 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{a}}}
3366 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{o}}}
3368 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
3369 \def\imacro{i}
3370 \def\jmacro{j}
3371 \def\dotless#1{%
3372 \def\temp{#1}%
3373 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
3374 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
3375 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
3376 \fi\fi
3379 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
3380 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
3382 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
3384 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
3385 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
3386 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
3387 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
3388 % \scriptscriptstyle).
3390 \def\LaTeX{%
3391 L\kern-.36em
3392 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
3393 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
3394 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
3395 % for 10pt running text, lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
3396 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
3397 \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
3398 \else
3399 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
3400 \switchtolllsize A%
3403 \vss
3405 \kern-.15em
3406 \TeX
3409 % Some math mode symbols. Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
3410 % unless we are already there. Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
3411 % but safer, and can't hurt.
3412 \def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
3413 \def\ensuredmath#1{$\relax#1$}
3415 \def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
3416 \def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
3417 \def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
3418 \def\minus{\ensuremath-}
3420 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
3421 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
3422 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
3423 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
3424 % whichever is larger.
3426 \def\dots{%
3427 \leavevmode
3428 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
3429 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
3430 \dimen0 = \wd0
3431 \else
3432 \dimen0 = 1.5em
3434 \hbox to \dimen0{%
3435 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
3436 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3437 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3438 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
3442 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
3444 \def\enddots{%
3445 \dots
3446 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
3449 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
3451 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
3452 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
3454 \def\point{$\star$}
3455 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
3456 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
3457 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
3458 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
3459 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
3461 % The @error{} command.
3462 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
3464 \newbox\errorbox
3466 {\ttfont \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
3467 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
3468 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
3469 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
3471 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
3472 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
3473 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
3474 \vbox{%
3475 \hrule height\dimen2
3476 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
3477 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
3478 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
3479 \hrule height\dimen2}
3480 \hfil}
3482 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
3484 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
3486 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
3488 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
3489 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
3490 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
3491 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
3492 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
3494 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
3495 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
3496 % font height.
3498 % feymr - regular
3499 % feymo - slanted
3500 % feybr - bold
3501 % feybo - bold slanted
3503 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
3504 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
3505 % Hmm.
3507 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
3508 % Hope not.
3511 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
3512 \def\eurofont{%
3513 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
3514 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
3515 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
3516 % font installed.
3518 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
3519 % that to the current nominal size.
3521 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
3522 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
3524 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3526 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3527 % bold:
3528 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
3529 \else
3530 % regular:
3531 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
3533 \thiseurofont
3536 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
3537 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
3538 % the redefinition.
3540 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
3541 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
3542 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
3543 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
3544 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
3546 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
3547 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
3548 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
3549 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
3550 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
3551 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
3552 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
3553 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
3555 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
3556 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
3557 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
3558 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
3560 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
3561 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
3562 % the same EC font.
3563 \def\ogonek#1{{%
3564 \def\temp{#1}%
3565 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
3566 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
3567 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
3568 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
3569 \else
3570 \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
3571 \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
3572 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
3574 \fi\fi\fi\fi
3577 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
3578 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
3579 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
3580 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
3582 % Use the European Computer Modern fonts (cm-super in outline format)
3583 % for non-CM glyphs. That is ec* for regular text and tc* for the text
3584 % companion symbols (LaTeX TS1 encoding). Both are part of the ec
3585 % package and follow the same conventions.
3587 \def\ecfont{\etcfont{e}}
3588 \def\tcfont{\etcfont{t}}
3590 \def\etcfont#1{%
3591 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
3592 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
3593 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
3594 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
3595 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
3596 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3597 \ifmonospace
3598 % typewriter:
3599 \font\thisecfont = #1ctt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3600 \else
3601 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3602 % bold:
3603 \font\thisecfont = #1cb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3604 \else
3605 % regular:
3606 \font\thisecfont = #1c\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3609 \thisecfont
3612 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
3613 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
3614 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
3616 \def\registeredsymbol{%
3617 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize R}%
3618 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
3622 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
3624 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
3626 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
3627 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
3628 % so we'll define it if necessary.
3630 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
3631 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
3634 % Quotes.
3635 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C
3636 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
3637 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
3638 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
3641 \message{page headings,}
3643 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
3644 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
3646 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
3647 \newif\ifseenauthor
3648 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
3650 % @setcontentsaftertitlepage used to do an implicit @contents or
3651 % @shortcontents after @end titlepage, but it is now obsolete.
3652 \def\setcontentsaftertitlepage{%
3653 \errmessage{@setcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
3654 command; move your @contents command if you want the contents
3655 after the title page.}}%
3656 \def\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage{%
3657 \errmessage{@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
3658 command; move your @shortcontents and @contents commands if you
3659 want the contents after the title page.}}%
3661 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
3662 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3663 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3665 \envdef\titlepage{%
3666 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3667 \begingroup
3668 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
3669 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3670 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3671 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3672 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3674 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3675 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3676 \let\oldpage = \page
3677 \def\page{%
3678 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3679 \finishtitlepage
3681 \let\page = \oldpage
3682 \page
3683 \null
3687 \def\Etitlepage{%
3688 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3689 \finishtitlepage
3691 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3692 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3693 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3694 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3695 \oldpage
3696 \endgroup
3698 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3699 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3700 \HEADINGSon
3703 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3704 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
3705 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3706 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3709 % Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
3710 % don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
3711 % inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. \par should
3712 % be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
3714 \def\raggedtitlesettings{%
3716 \hyphenpenalty=10000
3717 \parindent=0pt
3718 \tolerance=5000
3719 \ptexraggedright
3722 % Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3724 \let\subtitlerm=\rmfont
3725 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
3727 \parseargdef\title{%
3728 \checkenv\titlepage
3729 \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
3730 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3731 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3732 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
3735 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3736 \checkenv\titlepage
3737 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3740 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3741 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3743 \parseargdef\author{%
3744 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3745 \ifx\thisenv\temp
3746 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3747 \else
3748 \checkenv\titlepage
3749 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
3750 {\secfonts\rm \leftline{#1}}%
3755 % Set up page headings and footings.
3757 \let\thispage=\folio
3759 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3760 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3761 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3762 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3764 % Now make \makeheadline and \makefootline in Plain TeX use those variables
3765 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3766 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3767 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3768 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3769 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
3771 % Commands to set those variables.
3772 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3773 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3774 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3775 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3776 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3779 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3780 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3781 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3782 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3784 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3785 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3786 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3787 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3789 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3791 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3792 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3793 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3794 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3796 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3797 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3798 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3799 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3801 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3802 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3803 \global\advance\txipageheight by -12pt
3804 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
3807 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3809 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3810 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3812 % The same set of arguments for:
3814 % @oddheadingmarks
3815 % @evenfootingmarks
3816 % @oddfootingmarks
3817 % @everyheadingmarks
3818 % @everyfootingmarks
3820 % These define \getoddheadingmarks, \getevenheadingmarks,
3821 % \getoddfootingmarks, and \getevenfootingmarks, each to one of
3822 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks.
3824 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
3825 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
3826 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
3827 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
3828 \parseargdef\everyheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
3829 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
3830 \parseargdef\everyfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
3831 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
3832 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3833 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3834 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
3835 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
3838 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3839 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3841 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3842 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3843 % @headings off turns them off.
3844 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3845 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3846 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3847 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3848 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3849 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3851 \parseargdef\headings{\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
3853 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
3854 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
3855 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
3858 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
3859 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default
3861 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3862 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3863 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3864 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3865 % edge of all pages.
3866 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3867 \global\pageno=1
3868 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3869 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3870 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3871 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3872 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3874 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3876 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3877 % page number on top right.
3878 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3879 \global\pageno=1
3880 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3881 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3882 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3883 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3884 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3886 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3888 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
3889 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
3890 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3891 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3892 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3893 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3894 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3895 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3898 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
3899 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3900 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3901 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3902 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3903 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3904 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3907 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3908 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3909 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3910 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3911 \ifx\today\thisisundefined
3912 \def\today{%
3913 \number\day\space
3914 \ifcase\month
3915 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3916 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3917 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3919 \space\number\year}
3922 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3923 % It generates no output of its own.
3924 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3925 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3928 \message{tables,}
3929 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3931 % default indentation of table text
3932 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
3933 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3934 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
3935 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3936 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
3938 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3939 \newdimen\itemmax
3941 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3942 % these defs.
3943 % They also define \itemindex
3944 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3946 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3948 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3950 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3951 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3953 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3954 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
3955 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
3956 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3957 \itemindex{#1}%
3958 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3960 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3961 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3962 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3963 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3964 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3965 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
3967 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3968 % but leave it ragged-right.
3969 \begingroup
3970 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
3971 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
3972 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
3973 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3974 \endgroup
3976 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3977 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3978 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
3980 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3981 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3982 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3983 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3984 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3985 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3987 \penalty 10001
3988 \endgroup
3989 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3990 \else
3991 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3992 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3993 \noindent
3994 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3995 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3996 % eventually be printed.
3997 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
3998 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
3999 \unhbox0
4000 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
4001 \endgroup
4002 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
4006 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
4007 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
4009 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
4010 \envdef\table{%
4011 \let\itemindex\gobble
4012 \tablecheck{table}%
4014 \envdef\ftable{%
4015 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
4016 \tablecheck{ftable}%
4018 \envdef\vtable{%
4019 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
4020 \tablecheck{vtable}%
4022 \def\tablecheck#1{%
4023 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
4024 \endgroup
4025 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
4026 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
4027 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
4028 \else
4029 \let\next\tablex
4031 \next
4033 \def\tablex#1{%
4034 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
4035 \parsearg\tabley
4037 \def\tabley#1{%
4039 \makevalueexpandable
4040 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
4041 \expandafter
4042 }\temp \endtablez
4044 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
4045 \aboveenvbreak
4046 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
4047 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
4048 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
4049 \itemmax=\tableindent
4050 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
4051 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
4052 \exdentamount=\tableindent
4053 \parindent = 0pt
4054 \parskip = \smallskipamount
4055 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
4056 \let\item = \internalBitem
4057 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
4059 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
4060 \let\Eftable\Etable
4061 \let\Evtable\Etable
4062 \let\Eitemize\Etable
4063 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
4065 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
4067 \newcount \itemno
4069 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
4071 \def\doitemize#1{%
4072 \aboveenvbreak
4073 \itemmax=\itemindent
4074 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
4075 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
4076 \exdentamount=\itemindent
4077 \parindent=0pt
4078 \parskip=\smallskipamount
4079 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
4081 % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
4082 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
4083 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
4084 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
4085 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
4086 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
4087 \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
4089 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
4090 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
4092 \let\item=\itemizeitem
4095 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
4097 \def\itemizeitem{%
4098 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
4099 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
4101 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
4102 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
4103 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
4104 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
4105 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
4106 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
4107 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
4108 % that's the theory.
4109 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
4110 \noindent
4111 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
4113 \ifinner\else
4114 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}% not good to break after first line of item.
4116 % We can be in inner vertical mode in a footnote, although an
4117 % @itemize looks awful there.
4119 \flushcr
4122 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
4123 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
4125 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
4127 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
4128 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
4129 % argument is the same as `1'.
4131 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
4132 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
4133 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
4134 \def\thearg{#1}%
4135 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
4137 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
4138 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
4139 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
4140 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
4141 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
4142 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
4143 \ifx\rest\empty
4144 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
4145 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
4146 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
4147 % not equal to itself.
4148 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
4150 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
4151 % continuing to look for a <number>.
4153 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
4154 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
4155 \else
4156 % It's a letter.
4157 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
4158 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
4159 \else
4160 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
4163 \else
4164 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
4165 \numericenumerate
4169 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
4170 % given in \thearg.
4172 \def\numericenumerate{%
4173 \itemno = \thearg
4174 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
4177 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
4178 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
4179 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
4180 \startenumeration{%
4181 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
4182 \ifnum\itemno=0
4183 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
4184 alphabet}%
4186 \char\lccode\itemno
4190 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
4191 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
4192 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
4193 \startenumeration{%
4194 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
4195 \ifnum\itemno=0
4196 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
4197 alphabet}
4199 \char\uccode\itemno
4203 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
4204 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
4205 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
4207 \def\startenumeration#1{%
4208 \advance\itemno by -1
4209 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
4212 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
4213 % to @enumerate.
4215 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
4216 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
4217 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
4218 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
4221 % @multitable macros
4222 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
4224 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
4225 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
4226 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
4227 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
4229 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
4231 % To make preamble:
4233 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
4234 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
4235 % @item ...
4237 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
4238 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
4239 % columns as desired.
4242 % Or use a template:
4243 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
4244 % @item ...
4245 % using the widest term desired in each column.
4247 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
4248 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
4249 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
4250 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
4252 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
4253 % if they are.
4255 % Sample multitable:
4257 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
4258 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
4259 % @item
4260 % first col stuff
4261 % @tab
4262 % second col stuff
4263 % @tab
4264 % third col
4265 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
4266 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
4268 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
4269 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
4270 % @end multitable
4272 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
4273 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
4274 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
4275 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
4276 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
4277 % to baseline.
4278 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
4280 \newskip\multitableparskip
4281 \newskip\multitableparindent
4282 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
4283 \newskip\multitablelinespace
4284 \multitableparskip=0pt
4285 \multitableparindent=6pt
4286 \multitablecolspace=12pt
4287 \multitablelinespace=0pt
4289 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
4291 \let\endsetuptable\relax
4292 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
4293 \let\columnfractions\relax
4294 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
4295 \newif\ifsetpercent
4297 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
4298 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
4300 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
4301 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4302 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
4303 \setuptable
4306 \newcount\colcount
4307 \def\setuptable#1{%
4308 \def\firstarg{#1}%
4309 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
4310 \let\go = \relax
4311 \else
4312 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
4313 \global\setpercenttrue
4314 \else
4315 \ifsetpercent
4316 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
4317 \else
4318 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4319 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
4320 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
4321 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
4324 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
4325 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
4326 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
4327 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
4328 \else
4329 \let\go = \setuptable
4330 \fi%
4335 % multitable-only commands.
4337 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments
4338 % have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
4339 % alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
4340 % undo it ourselves.
4341 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
4342 \def\headitem{%
4343 \checkenv\multitable
4344 \crcr
4345 \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
4346 \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
4347 \the\everytab % for the first item
4350 % default for tables with no headings.
4351 \let\headitemcrhook=\relax
4353 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
4354 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
4355 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
4356 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
4357 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
4359 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
4361 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
4363 \envdef\multitable{%
4364 \vskip\parskip
4365 \startsavinginserts
4367 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
4368 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
4369 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
4370 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
4371 \def\item{\crcr}%
4373 \tolerance=9500
4374 \hbadness=9500
4375 \setmultitablespacing
4376 \parskip=\multitableparskip
4377 \parindent=\multitableparindent
4378 \overfullrule=0pt
4379 \global\colcount=0
4381 \everycr = {%
4382 \noalign{%
4383 \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem.
4384 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
4386 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
4387 \checkinserts
4389 % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
4390 \headitemcrhook
4391 \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
4395 \parsearg\domultitable
4397 \def\domultitable#1{%
4398 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
4399 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
4401 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
4402 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
4403 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
4404 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
4405 \halign\bgroup &%
4406 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4407 \multistrut
4408 \vtop{%
4409 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
4410 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
4412 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
4413 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
4414 % the first one.
4416 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
4417 % to the width of each template entry.
4419 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
4420 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
4421 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
4422 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
4424 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
4425 \rightskip=0pt
4426 \ifnum\colcount=1
4427 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
4428 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
4429 \else
4430 \ifsetpercent \else
4431 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
4432 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
4433 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
4435 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
4436 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
4438 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
4439 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
4440 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
4441 % For example:
4442 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
4443 % @item @code{#}
4444 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
4445 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
4446 % marking characters.
4447 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
4448 }\cr
4450 \def\Emultitable{%
4451 \crcr
4452 \egroup % end the \halign
4453 \global\setpercentfalse
4456 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
4457 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
4459 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
4460 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
4461 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
4462 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
4463 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
4464 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
4465 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
4467 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
4468 % table. If not, do nothing.
4469 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
4470 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
4471 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4472 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4473 % than skip between lines in the table.
4474 \fi%
4475 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
4476 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4477 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4478 % than skip between lines in the table.
4479 \fi}
4482 \message{conditionals,}
4484 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
4485 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
4486 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
4487 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
4488 % attempt to close an environment group.
4490 \def\makecond#1{%
4491 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
4492 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
4494 \makecond{iftex}
4495 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
4496 \makecond{ifnothtml}
4497 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
4498 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
4499 \makecond{ifnotxml}
4501 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
4503 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
4504 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
4505 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
4506 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
4507 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
4508 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
4509 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
4510 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
4511 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
4512 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
4513 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
4514 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
4515 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
4517 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
4519 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
4520 \newcount\doignorecount
4522 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
4523 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
4524 \obeylines
4525 \catcode`\@ = \other
4526 \catcode`\{ = \other
4527 \catcode`\} = \other
4529 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
4530 \spaceisspace
4532 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
4533 \doignorecount = 0
4535 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
4536 \dodoignore{#1}%
4539 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
4540 \obeylines %
4542 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
4543 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
4545 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
4546 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
4547 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
4549 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
4550 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
4551 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
4552 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
4554 % And now expand that command.
4555 \doignoretext ^^M%
4559 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
4560 \def\temp{#1}%
4561 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
4562 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
4563 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
4564 \advance\doignorecount by 1
4565 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
4566 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
4568 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
4571 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
4573 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
4574 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
4575 \let\next\enddoignore
4576 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
4577 \advance\doignorecount by -1
4578 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
4580 \next
4583 % Finish off ignored text.
4584 { \obeylines%
4585 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
4586 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
4587 % would result in a blank line in the output.
4588 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
4592 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
4593 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
4595 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
4596 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
4597 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
4598 % didn't need it.
4599 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
4601 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
4602 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
4604 \makevalueexpandable
4605 \def\temp{#2}%
4606 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
4607 \ifx\temp\empty
4608 \next{}%
4609 \else
4610 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
4614 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
4615 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
4617 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
4619 \parseargdef\clear{%
4621 \makevalueexpandable
4622 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
4626 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
4627 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
4628 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
4630 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
4632 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
4633 \let\value = \expandablevalue
4634 % We don't want these characters active, ...
4635 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
4636 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
4637 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
4638 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
4639 \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
4643 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
4644 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
4645 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
4646 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
4647 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
4648 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
4649 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
4651 % Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value*
4652 % of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr
4653 % dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's
4654 % been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it.
4656 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
4657 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4658 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
4659 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
4660 \else
4661 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4665 % Like \expandablevalue, but completely expandable (the \message in the
4666 % definition above operates at the execution level of TeX). Used when
4667 % writing to auxiliary files, due to the expansion that \write does.
4668 % If flag is undefined, pass through an unexpanded @value command: maybe it
4669 % will be set by the time it is read back in.
4671 % NB flag names containing - or _ may not work here.
4672 \def\dummyvalue#1{%
4673 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4674 \noexpand\value{#1}%
4675 \else
4676 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4680 % Used for @value's in index entries to form the sort key: expand the @value
4681 % if possible, otherwise sort late.
4682 \def\indexnofontsvalue#1{%
4683 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4684 ZZZZZZZ
4685 \else
4686 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4690 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
4691 % with @set.
4693 % To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
4694 % \makecond and then redefine.
4696 \makecond{ifset}
4697 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
4698 \def\doifset#1#2{%
4700 \makevalueexpandable
4701 \let\next=\empty
4702 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
4703 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
4705 \expandafter
4706 }\next
4708 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
4710 % @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
4711 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
4713 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
4714 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
4715 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
4717 \makecond{ifclear}
4718 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
4719 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
4721 % @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
4722 % without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
4723 % TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
4724 % defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
4726 \makecond{ifcommanddefined}
4727 \def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
4729 \def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
4730 \makevalueexpandable
4731 \let\next=\empty
4732 \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
4733 #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
4735 \expandafter
4736 }\next
4738 \def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
4740 % @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
4741 \makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
4742 \def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
4743 \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
4744 \def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
4746 % Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
4747 % test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
4748 \set txicommandconditionals
4750 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4751 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4752 \let\dircategory=\comment
4754 % @defininfoenclose.
4755 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
4758 \message{indexing,}
4759 % Index generation facilities
4761 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4762 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4763 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
4765 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named IX.
4766 % It automatically defines \IXindex such that
4767 % \IXindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index IX.
4768 % It also defines \IXindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4769 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is IX.
4770 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4771 % for the sake of vms.
4773 \def\newindex#1{%
4774 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
4775 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4776 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4779 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4781 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4783 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4785 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4787 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4788 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
4789 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
4790 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4793 % The default indices:
4794 \newindex{cp}% concepts,
4795 \newcodeindex{fn}% functions,
4796 \newcodeindex{vr}% variables,
4797 \newcodeindex{tp}% types,
4798 \newcodeindex{ky}% keys
4799 \newcodeindex{pg}% and programs.
4802 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4803 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4805 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4806 % inside @code.
4808 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4809 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4811 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4812 % #3 the target index (bar).
4813 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4814 \requireopenindexfile{#3}%
4815 % redefine \fooindfile:
4816 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
4817 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
4818 % redefine \fooindex:
4819 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4822 % Define \doindex, the driver for all index macros.
4823 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4824 % and it is the two-letter name of the index.
4826 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\doindexxxx}
4827 \def\doindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4829 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4830 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\docodeindexxxx}
4831 \def\docodeindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4834 % Used when writing an index entry out to an index file to prevent
4835 % expansion of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4837 \def\indexdummies{%
4838 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
4839 \definedummyletter\@%
4840 \definedummyletter\ %
4842 % For texindex which always views { and } as separators.
4843 \def\{{\lbracechar{}}%
4844 \def\}{\rbracechar{}}%
4846 % Do the redefinitions.
4847 \definedummies
4850 % Used for the aux and toc files, where @ is the escape character.
4852 \def\atdummies{%
4853 \definedummyletter\@%
4854 \definedummyletter\ %
4855 \definedummyletter\{%
4856 \definedummyletter\}%
4858 % Do the redefinitions.
4859 \definedummies
4860 \otherbackslash
4863 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4864 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
4865 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4866 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4867 % from whatever follows.
4869 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4870 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4871 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4873 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4874 % space.
4876 \def\definedummyword #1{\def#1{\string#1\space}}%
4877 \def\definedummyletter#1{\def#1{\string#1}}%
4878 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4880 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies, to effectively prevent
4881 % the expansion of commands.
4883 \def\definedummies{%
4885 \let\commondummyword\definedummyword
4886 \let\commondummyletter\definedummyletter
4887 \let\commondummyaccent\definedummyaccent
4888 \commondummiesnofonts
4890 \definedummyletter\_%
4891 \definedummyletter\-%
4893 % Non-English letters.
4894 \definedummyword\AA
4895 \definedummyword\AE
4896 \definedummyword\DH
4897 \definedummyword\L
4898 \definedummyword\O
4899 \definedummyword\OE
4900 \definedummyword\TH
4901 \definedummyword\aa
4902 \definedummyword\ae
4903 \definedummyword\dh
4904 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4905 \definedummyword\l
4906 \definedummyword\o
4907 \definedummyword\oe
4908 \definedummyword\ordf
4909 \definedummyword\ordm
4910 \definedummyword\questiondown
4911 \definedummyword\ss
4912 \definedummyword\th
4914 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4915 \definedummyword\bf
4916 \definedummyword\gtr
4917 \definedummyword\hat
4918 \definedummyword\less
4919 \definedummyword\sf
4920 \definedummyword\sl
4921 \definedummyword\tclose
4922 \definedummyword\tt
4924 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4925 \definedummyword\TeX
4927 % Assorted special characters.
4928 \definedummyword\atchar
4929 \definedummyword\arrow
4930 \definedummyword\bullet
4931 \definedummyword\comma
4932 \definedummyword\copyright
4933 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4934 \definedummyword\dots
4935 \definedummyword\enddots
4936 \definedummyword\entrybreak
4937 \definedummyword\equiv
4938 \definedummyword\error
4939 \definedummyword\euro
4940 \definedummyword\expansion
4941 \definedummyword\geq
4942 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4943 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4944 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4945 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4946 \definedummyword\lbracechar
4947 \definedummyword\leq
4948 \definedummyword\mathopsup
4949 \definedummyword\minus
4950 \definedummyword\ogonek
4951 \definedummyword\pounds
4952 \definedummyword\point
4953 \definedummyword\print
4954 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4955 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4956 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4957 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4958 \definedummyword\quoteright
4959 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4960 \definedummyword\rbracechar
4961 \definedummyword\result
4962 \definedummyword\sub
4963 \definedummyword\sup
4964 \definedummyword\textdegree
4966 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4967 \macrolist
4968 \let\value\dummyvalue
4970 \normalturnoffactive
4973 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \definedummies and \indexnofonts.
4974 % Define \commondummyletter, \commondummyaccent and \commondummyword before
4975 % using. Used for accents, font commands, and various control letters.
4977 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4978 % Control letters and accents.
4979 \commondummyletter\!%
4980 \commondummyaccent\"%
4981 \commondummyaccent\'%
4982 \commondummyletter\*%
4983 \commondummyaccent\,%
4984 \commondummyletter\.%
4985 \commondummyletter\/%
4986 \commondummyletter\:%
4987 \commondummyaccent\=%
4988 \commondummyletter\?%
4989 \commondummyaccent\^%
4990 \commondummyaccent\`%
4991 \commondummyaccent\~%
4992 \commondummyword\u
4993 \commondummyword\v
4994 \commondummyword\H
4995 \commondummyword\dotaccent
4996 \commondummyword\ogonek
4997 \commondummyword\ringaccent
4998 \commondummyword\tieaccent
4999 \commondummyword\ubaraccent
5000 \commondummyword\udotaccent
5001 \commondummyword\dotless
5003 % Texinfo font commands.
5004 \commondummyword\b
5005 \commondummyword\i
5006 \commondummyword\r
5007 \commondummyword\sansserif
5008 \commondummyword\sc
5009 \commondummyword\slanted
5010 \commondummyword\t
5012 % Commands that take arguments.
5013 \commondummyword\abbr
5014 \commondummyword\acronym
5015 \commondummyword\anchor
5016 \commondummyword\cite
5017 \commondummyword\code
5018 \commondummyword\command
5019 \commondummyword\dfn
5020 \commondummyword\dmn
5021 \commondummyword\email
5022 \commondummyword\emph
5023 \commondummyword\env
5024 \commondummyword\file
5025 \commondummyword\image
5026 \commondummyword\indicateurl
5027 \commondummyword\inforef
5028 \commondummyword\kbd
5029 \commondummyword\key
5030 \commondummyword\math
5031 \commondummyword\option
5032 \commondummyword\pxref
5033 \commondummyword\ref
5034 \commondummyword\samp
5035 \commondummyword\strong
5036 \commondummyword\tie
5037 \commondummyword\U
5038 \commondummyword\uref
5039 \commondummyword\url
5040 \commondummyword\var
5041 \commondummyword\verb
5042 \commondummyword\w
5043 \commondummyword\xref
5046 % For testing: output @{ and @} in index sort strings as \{ and \}.
5047 \newif\ifusebracesinindexes
5049 \let\indexlbrace\relax
5050 \let\indexrbrace\relax
5052 {\catcode`\@=0
5053 \catcode`\\=13
5054 @gdef@backslashdisappear{@def\{}}
5058 \catcode`\<=13
5059 \catcode`\-=13
5060 \catcode`\`=13
5061 \gdef\indexnonalnumdisappear{%
5062 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax\else
5063 % @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us ignore left quotes in the sort term.
5064 % (Introduced for FSFS 2nd ed.)
5065 \let`=\empty
5068 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexbackslashignore\endcsname\relax\else
5069 \backslashdisappear
5072 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexhyphenignore\endcsname\relax\else
5073 \def-{}%
5075 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlessthanignore\endcsname\relax\else
5076 \def<{}%
5078 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexatsignignore\endcsname\relax\else
5079 \def\@{}%
5083 \gdef\indexnonalnumreappear{%
5084 \useindexbackslash
5085 \let-\normaldash
5086 \let<\normalless
5087 \def\@{@}%
5092 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
5093 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
5094 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
5095 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
5097 \def\indexnofonts{%
5098 % Accent commands should become @asis.
5099 \def\commondummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
5100 % We can just ignore other control letters.
5101 \def\commondummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
5102 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
5103 \let\commondummyword\commondummyaccent
5104 \commondummiesnofonts
5106 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
5107 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
5108 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
5109 %\let\tt=\asis
5111 \def\ { }%
5112 \def\@{@}%
5113 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
5114 \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
5116 \uccode`\1=`\{ \uppercase{\def\{{1}}%
5117 \uccode`\1=`\} \uppercase{\def\}{1}}%
5118 \let\lbracechar\{%
5119 \let\rbracechar\}%
5121 % Non-English letters.
5122 \def\AA{AA}%
5123 \def\AE{AE}%
5124 \def\DH{DZZ}%
5125 \def\L{L}%
5126 \def\OE{OE}%
5127 \def\O{O}%
5128 \def\TH{TH}%
5129 \def\aa{aa}%
5130 \def\ae{ae}%
5131 \def\dh{dzz}%
5132 \def\exclamdown{!}%
5133 \def\l{l}%
5134 \def\oe{oe}%
5135 \def\ordf{a}%
5136 \def\ordm{o}%
5137 \def\o{o}%
5138 \def\questiondown{?}%
5139 \def\ss{ss}%
5140 \def\th{th}%
5142 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
5143 \def\TeX{TeX}%
5145 % Assorted special characters. \defglyph gives the control sequence a
5146 % definition that removes the {} that follows its use.
5147 \defglyph\atchar{@}%
5148 \defglyph\arrow{->}%
5149 \defglyph\bullet{bullet}%
5150 \defglyph\comma{,}%
5151 \defglyph\copyright{copyright}%
5152 \defglyph\dots{...}%
5153 \defglyph\enddots{...}%
5154 \defglyph\equiv{==}%
5155 \defglyph\error{error}%
5156 \defglyph\euro{euro}%
5157 \defglyph\expansion{==>}%
5158 \defglyph\geq{>=}%
5159 \defglyph\guillemetleft{<<}%
5160 \defglyph\guillemetright{>>}%
5161 \defglyph\guilsinglleft{<}%
5162 \defglyph\guilsinglright{>}%
5163 \defglyph\leq{<=}%
5164 \defglyph\lbracechar{\{}%
5165 \defglyph\minus{-}%
5166 \defglyph\point{.}%
5167 \defglyph\pounds{pounds}%
5168 \defglyph\print{-|}%
5169 \defglyph\quotedblbase{"}%
5170 \defglyph\quotedblleft{"}%
5171 \defglyph\quotedblright{"}%
5172 \defglyph\quoteleft{`}%
5173 \defglyph\quoteright{'}%
5174 \defglyph\quotesinglbase{,}%
5175 \defglyph\rbracechar{\}}%
5176 \defglyph\registeredsymbol{R}%
5177 \defglyph\result{=>}%
5178 \defglyph\textdegree{o}%
5180 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
5181 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
5182 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
5183 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
5184 % that starts with \.
5186 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
5187 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
5188 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
5190 \macrolist
5191 \let\value\indexnofontsvalue
5193 \def\defglyph#1#2{\def#1##1{#2}} % see above
5198 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
5200 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
5201 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
5202 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
5204 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
5205 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
5206 % TODO: Two-level index? Operation index?
5208 % Workhorse for all indexes.
5209 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
5210 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
5211 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
5213 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
5214 \iflinks
5216 \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
5217 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
5218 \toks0 = {#2}%
5219 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
5220 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
5221 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
5222 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
5225 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
5227 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
5232 % Check if an index file has been opened, and if not, open it.
5233 \def\requireopenindexfile#1{%
5234 \ifnum\csname #1indfile\endcsname=0
5235 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
5236 \edef\suffix{#1}%
5237 % A .fls suffix would conflict with the file extension for the output
5238 % of -recorder, so use .f1s instead.
5239 \ifx\suffix\indexisfl\def\suffix{f1}\fi
5240 % Open the file
5241 \immediate\openout\csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.\suffix
5242 % Using \immediate above here prevents an object entering into the current
5243 % box, which could confound checks such as those in \safewhatsit for
5244 % preceding skips.
5245 \typeout{Writing index file \jobname.\suffix}%
5246 \fi}
5247 \def\indexisfl{fl}
5249 % Output \ as {\indexbackslash}, because \ is an escape character in
5250 % the index files.
5251 \let\indexbackslash=\relax
5252 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
5253 @gdef@useindexbackslash{@def\{{@indexbackslash}}}
5256 % Definition for writing index entry text.
5257 \def\sortas#1{\ignorespaces}%
5259 % Definition for writing index entry sort key. Should occur at the at
5260 % the beginning of the index entry, like
5261 % @cindex @sortas{september} \september
5262 % The \ignorespaces takes care of following space, but there's no way
5263 % to remove space before it.
5265 \catcode`\-=13
5266 \gdef\indexwritesortas{%
5267 \begingroup
5268 \indexnonalnumreappear
5269 \indexwritesortasxxx}
5270 \gdef\indexwritesortasxxx#1{%
5271 \xdef\indexsortkey{#1}\endgroup}
5275 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file.
5277 \def\dosubindwrite{%
5278 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
5279 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
5280 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
5283 % Remember, we are within a group.
5284 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
5285 \useindexbackslash % \indexbackslash isn't defined now so it will be output
5286 % as is; and it will print as backslash.
5287 % The braces around \indexbrace are recognized by texindex.
5289 % Get the string to sort by, by processing the index entry with all
5290 % font commands turned off.
5291 {\indexnofonts
5292 \def\lbracechar{{\indexlbrace}}%
5293 \def\rbracechar{{\indexrbrace}}%
5294 \let\{=\lbracechar
5295 \let\}=\rbracechar
5296 \indexnonalnumdisappear
5297 \xdef\indexsortkey{}%
5298 \let\sortas=\indexwritesortas
5299 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}%
5300 \setbox\dummybox = \hbox{\temp}% Make sure to execute any \sortas
5301 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty
5302 \xdef\indexsortkey{\temp}%
5303 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty\xdef\indexsortkey{ }\fi
5307 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
5308 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
5309 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
5310 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
5311 % sorted result.
5312 \edef\temp{%
5313 \write\writeto{%
5314 \string\entry{\indexsortkey}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
5316 \temp
5318 \newbox\dummybox % used above
5320 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
5322 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
5323 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
5324 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
5325 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
5326 % sequences like this:
5327 % @end defun
5328 % @tindex whatever
5329 % @defun ...
5330 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
5331 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
5332 % the previous defun.
5334 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
5335 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
5337 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
5339 % But wait, there is a catch there:
5340 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
5341 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
5342 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
5343 % representation of the skip.
5345 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
5346 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
5348 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
5350 \newskip\whatsitskip
5351 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
5353 % ..., ready, GO:
5355 \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
5357 \else
5358 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
5359 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
5360 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
5361 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
5363 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
5364 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
5365 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
5366 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
5367 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
5368 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5369 \else
5370 \vskip-\whatsitskip
5375 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5376 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
5377 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
5378 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
5379 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
5380 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
5381 % @deffn deffn-whatever
5382 % @vindex index-whatever
5383 % Description.
5384 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
5385 % and the "Description." paragraph.
5386 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
5387 \else
5388 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
5389 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
5390 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
5391 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
5393 \fi}
5395 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
5396 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
5397 % or
5398 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
5399 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
5400 % containing these kinds of lines:
5401 % \initial {c}
5402 % before the first topic whose initial is c
5403 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
5404 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
5405 % \primary {topic}
5406 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
5407 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
5408 % for each subtopic.
5410 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
5411 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
5413 \def\findex {\fnindex}
5414 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
5415 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
5416 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
5417 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
5418 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
5420 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
5421 {\obeylines %
5422 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
5423 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
5425 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
5427 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
5428 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
5430 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
5431 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
5433 \smallfonts \rm
5434 \tolerance = 9500
5435 \plainfrenchspacing
5436 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
5438 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
5439 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
5440 % \initial {@}
5441 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
5442 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
5443 \catcode`\@ = 12
5444 % See comment in \requireopenindexfile.
5445 \def\indexname{#1}\ifx\indexname\indexisfl\def\indexname{f1}\fi
5446 \openin 1 \jobname.\indexname s
5447 \ifeof 1
5448 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
5449 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
5450 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
5451 % there is some text.
5452 \putwordIndexNonexistent
5453 \typeout{No file \jobname.\indexname s.}%
5454 \else
5455 \catcode`\\ = 0
5457 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
5458 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
5459 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
5460 \read 1 to \thisline
5461 \ifeof 1
5462 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
5463 \else
5464 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
5465 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
5466 % to make right now.
5467 \def\indexbackslash{\ttbackslash}%
5468 \let\indexlbrace\{ % Likewise, set these sequences for braces
5469 \let\indexrbrace\} % used in the sort key.
5470 \begindoublecolumns
5471 \let\dotheinsertentrybox\dotheinsertentryboxwithpenalty
5473 % Read input from the index file line by line.
5474 \loopdo
5475 \ifeof1 \else
5476 \read 1 to \nextline
5479 \indexinputprocessing
5480 \thisline
5482 \ifeof1\else
5483 \let\thisline\nextline
5484 \repeat
5486 \enddoublecolumns
5489 \closein 1
5490 \endgroup}
5491 \def\loopdo#1\repeat{\def\body{#1}\loopdoxxx}
5492 \def\loopdoxxx{\let\next=\relax\body\let\next=\loopdoxxx\fi\next}
5494 \def\indexinputprocessing{%
5495 \ifeof1
5496 \let\firsttoken\relax
5497 \else
5498 \edef\act{\gdef\noexpand\firsttoken{\getfirsttoken\nextline}}%
5499 \act
5502 \def\getfirsttoken#1{\expandafter\getfirsttokenx#1\endfirsttoken}
5503 \long\def\getfirsttokenx#1#2\endfirsttoken{\noexpand#1}
5506 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
5507 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
5509 {\catcode`\/=13 \catcode`\-=13 \catcode`\^=13 \catcode`\~=13 \catcode`\_=13
5510 \catcode`\|=13 \catcode`\<=13 \catcode`\>=13 \catcode`\+=13 \catcode`\"=13
5511 \catcode`\$=3
5512 \gdef\initialglyphs{%
5513 % Some changes for non-alphabetic characters. Using the glyphs from the
5514 % math fonts looks more consistent than the typewriter font used elsewhere
5515 % for these characters.
5516 \def\indexbackslash{\math{\backslash}}%
5517 \let\\=\indexbackslash
5519 % Can't get bold backslash so don't use bold forward slash
5520 \catcode`\/=13
5521 \def/{{\secrmnotbold \normalslash}}%
5522 \def-{{\normaldash\normaldash}}% en dash `--'
5523 \def^{{\chapbf \normalcaret}}%
5524 \def~{{\chapbf \normaltilde}}%
5525 \def\_{%
5526 \leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }%
5527 \def|{$\vert$}%
5528 \def<{$\less$}%
5529 \def>{$\gtr$}%
5530 \def+{$\normalplus$}%
5533 \def\initial{%
5534 \bgroup
5535 \initialglyphs
5536 \initialx
5539 \def\initialx#1{%
5540 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
5541 \removelastskip
5543 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
5544 % The glue before the bonus allows a little bit of space at the
5545 % bottom of a column to reduce an increase in inter-line spacing.
5546 \nobreak
5547 \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
5548 \penalty -300
5549 \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
5551 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
5552 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
5553 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
5554 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
5556 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
5557 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus 1\baselineskip
5558 \leftline{\secfonts \kern-0.05em \secbf #1}%
5559 % \secfonts is inside the argument of \leftline so that the change of
5560 % \baselineskip will not affect any glue inserted before the vbox that
5561 % \leftline creates.
5562 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
5563 \nobreak
5564 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
5565 \egroup % \initialglyphs
5568 \newdimen\entryrightmargin
5569 \entryrightmargin=0pt
5571 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
5572 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
5573 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
5575 \def\entry{%
5576 \begingroup
5578 % For pdfTeX and XeTeX.
5579 % The redefinition of \domark stops marks being added in \pdflink to
5580 % preserve coloured links across page boundaries. Otherwise the marks
5581 % would get in the way of \lastbox in \insertentrybox.
5582 \let\domark\relax
5584 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
5585 % affect previous text.
5586 \par
5588 % No extra space above this paragraph.
5589 \parskip = 0in
5591 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
5592 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
5593 % titles, for instance.
5594 \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5595 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% An undocumented command
5597 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
5598 \afterassignment\doentry
5599 \let\temp =
5601 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5602 \def\doentry{%
5603 % Save the text of the entry
5604 \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
5605 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
5606 \noindent
5607 \aftergroup\finishentry
5608 % And now comes the text of the entry.
5609 % Not absorbing as a macro argument reduces the chance of problems
5610 % with catcodes occurring.
5612 {\catcode`\@=11
5613 \gdef\finishentry#1{%
5614 \egroup % end box A
5615 \dimen@ = \wd\boxA % Length of text of entry
5616 \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup\unhbox\boxA
5617 % #1 is the page number.
5619 % Get the width of the page numbers, and only use
5620 % leaders if they are present.
5621 \global\setbox\boxB = \hbox{#1}%
5622 \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
5623 \null\nobreak\hfill\ %
5624 \else
5626 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
5628 \ifpdf
5629 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5630 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
5631 \else
5632 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
5633 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable #1%
5634 \else
5635 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5636 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
5640 \egroup % end \boxA
5641 \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
5642 \global\setbox\entrybox=\vbox{\unhbox\boxA}%
5643 \else
5644 \global\setbox\entrybox=\vbox\bgroup
5645 % We want the text of the entries to be aligned to the left, and the
5646 % page numbers to be aligned to the right.
5648 \parindent = 0pt
5649 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fil
5650 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus -1fill
5651 \rightskip = 0pt plus -1fil
5652 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fill
5653 % Cause last line, which could consist of page numbers on their own
5654 % if the list of page numbers is long, to be aligned to the right.
5655 \parfillskip=0pt plus -1fill
5657 \advance\rightskip by \entryrightmargin
5658 % Determine how far we can stretch into the margin.
5659 % This allows, e.g., "Appendix H GNU Free Documentation License" to
5660 % fit on one line in @letterpaper format.
5661 \ifdim\entryrightmargin>2.1em
5662 \dimen@i=2.1em
5663 \else
5664 \dimen@i=0em
5666 \advance \parfillskip by 0pt minus 1\dimen@i
5668 \dimen@ii = \hsize
5669 \advance\dimen@ii by -1\leftskip
5670 \advance\dimen@ii by -1\entryrightmargin
5671 \advance\dimen@ii by 1\dimen@i
5672 \ifdim\wd\boxA > \dimen@ii % If the entry doesn't fit in one line
5673 \ifdim\dimen@ > 0.8\dimen@ii % due to long index text
5674 % Try to split the text roughly evenly. \dimen@ will be the length of
5675 % the first line.
5676 \dimen@ = 0.7\dimen@
5677 \dimen@ii = \hsize
5678 \ifnum\dimen@>\dimen@ii
5679 % If the entry is too long (for example, if it needs more than
5680 % two lines), use all the space in the first line.
5681 \dimen@ = \dimen@ii
5683 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill % ragged right
5684 \advance \dimen@ by 1\rightskip
5685 \parshape = 2 0pt \dimen@ 0em \dimen@ii
5686 % Ideally we'd add a finite glue at the end of the first line only,
5687 % instead of using \parshape with explicit line lengths, but TeX
5688 % doesn't seem to provide a way to do such a thing.
5690 % Indent all lines but the first one.
5691 \advance\leftskip by 1em
5692 \advance\parindent by -1em
5693 \fi\fi
5694 \indent % start paragraph
5695 \unhbox\boxA
5697 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
5698 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
5700 % Word spacing - no stretch
5701 \spaceskip=\fontdimen2\font minus \fontdimen4\font
5703 \linepenalty=1000 % Discourage line breaks.
5704 \hyphenpenalty=5000 % Discourage hyphenation.
5706 \par % format the paragraph
5707 \egroup % The \vbox
5709 \endgroup
5710 \dotheinsertentrybox
5713 \newskip\thinshrinkable
5714 \skip\thinshrinkable=.15em minus .15em
5716 \newbox\entrybox
5717 \def\insertentrybox{%
5718 \ourunvbox\entrybox
5721 % default definition
5722 \let\dotheinsertentrybox\insertentrybox
5724 % Use \lastbox to take apart vbox box by box, and add each sub-box
5725 % to the current vertical list.
5726 \def\ourunvbox#1{%
5727 \bgroup % for local binding of \delayedbox
5728 % Remove the last box from box #1
5729 \global\setbox#1=\vbox{%
5730 \unvbox#1%
5731 \unskip % remove any glue
5732 \unpenalty
5733 \global\setbox\interbox=\lastbox
5735 \setbox\delayedbox=\box\interbox
5736 \ifdim\ht#1=0pt\else
5737 \ourunvbox#1 % Repeat on what's left of the box
5738 \nobreak
5740 \box\delayedbox
5741 \egroup
5743 \newbox\delayedbox
5744 \newbox\interbox
5746 % Used from \printindex. \firsttoken should be the first token
5747 % after the \entry. If it's not another \entry, we are at the last
5748 % line of a group of index entries, so insert a penalty to discourage
5749 % widowed index entries.
5750 \def\dotheinsertentryboxwithpenalty{%
5751 \ifx\firsttoken\isentry
5752 \else
5753 \penalty 9000
5755 \insertentrybox
5757 \def\isentry{\entry}%
5759 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
5760 % The filll stretch here overpowers both the fil and fill stretch to push
5761 % the page number to the right.
5762 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
5763 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1filll}
5766 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
5768 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
5769 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
5770 \parfillskip=0in
5771 \parskip=0in
5772 \hangindent=1in
5773 \hangafter=1
5774 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
5775 \ifpdf
5776 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5777 \else
5778 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
5780 \else
5781 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5784 \par
5787 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
5788 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
5789 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
5790 \catcode`\@=11 % private names
5792 \newbox\partialpage
5793 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
5795 % Use inside an output routine to save \topmark and \firstmark
5796 \def\savemarks{%
5797 \global\savedtopmark=\expandafter{\topmark }%
5798 \global\savedfirstmark=\expandafter{\firstmark }%
5800 \newtoks\savedtopmark
5801 \newtoks\savedfirstmark
5803 % Set \topmark and \firstmark for next time \output runs.
5804 % Can't be run from withinside \output (because any material
5805 % added while an output routine is active, including
5806 % penalties, is saved for after it finishes). The page so far
5807 % should be empty, otherwise what's on it will be thrown away.
5808 \def\restoremarks{%
5809 \mark{\the\savedtopmark}%
5810 \bgroup\output = {%
5811 \setbox\dummybox=\box\PAGE
5812 }abc\eject\egroup
5813 % "abc" because output routine doesn't fire for a completely empty page.
5814 \mark{\the\savedfirstmark}%
5817 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
5818 % If not much space left on page, start a new page.
5819 \ifdim\pagetotal>0.8\vsize\vfill\eject\fi
5821 % Grab any single-column material above us.
5822 \output = {%
5824 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
5825 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
5826 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
5827 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
5828 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
5829 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
5830 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
5831 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
5832 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
5835 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
5836 % Unvbox the main output page.
5837 \unvbox\PAGE
5838 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
5840 \savemarks
5842 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
5843 \restoremarks
5845 % We recover the two marks that the last output routine saved in order
5846 % to propagate the information in marks added around a chapter heading,
5847 % which could be otherwise be lost by the time the final page is output.
5850 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
5851 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
5853 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
5854 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
5855 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
5856 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
5857 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
5859 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
5860 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
5861 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
5862 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
5863 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
5865 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
5866 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
5867 % been clobbered.
5869 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
5870 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
5871 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
5872 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5874 % Double the \vsize as well.
5875 \advance\vsize by -\ht\partialpage
5876 \vsize = 2\vsize
5878 % For the benefit of balancing columns
5879 \advance\baselineskip by 0pt plus 0.5pt
5882 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
5883 % the last, which is done by \balancecolumns.
5885 \def\doublecolumnout{%
5887 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
5888 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
5889 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
5890 % previous page.
5891 \dimen@ = \vsize
5892 \divide\dimen@ by 2
5894 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
5895 \setbox0=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@
5896 \global\advance\vsize by 2\ht\partialpage
5897 \onepageout\pagesofar
5898 \unvbox\PAGE
5899 \penalty\outputpenalty
5902 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
5903 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
5904 \def\pagesofar{%
5905 \unvbox\partialpage
5907 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5908 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
5909 \hbox to\txipagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
5913 % Finished with with double columns.
5914 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
5915 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
5916 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
5917 % following situation:
5919 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
5920 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
5921 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
5922 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
5923 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
5924 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
5925 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
5926 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
5927 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
5928 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
5929 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
5930 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
5931 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
5932 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
5933 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
5934 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
5935 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
5936 % and the final section into the vbox of \txipageheight (see
5937 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
5939 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
5940 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
5941 \penalty0
5943 \output = {%
5944 % Split the last of the double-column material.
5945 \savemarks
5946 \balancecolumns
5948 \eject % call the \output just set
5949 \ifdim\pagetotal=0pt
5950 % Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
5951 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
5952 % definition right away.
5953 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
5955 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
5956 \restoremarks
5957 % Leave the double-column material on the current page, no automatic
5958 % page break.
5959 \box\balancedcolumns
5961 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
5962 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
5963 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize.
5964 \global\vsize = \txipageheight %
5965 \pagegoal = \txipageheight %
5966 \else
5967 % We had some left-over material. This might happen when \doublecolumnout
5968 % is called in \balancecolumns. Try again.
5969 \expandafter\enddoublecolumns
5972 \newbox\balancedcolumns
5973 \setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{shouldnt see this}%
5975 % Only called for the last of the double column material. \doublecolumnout
5976 % does the others.
5977 \def\balancecolumns{%
5978 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox\PAGE}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
5979 \dimen@ = \ht0
5980 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
5981 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
5982 \ifdim\dimen@<5\baselineskip
5983 % Don't split a short final column in two.
5984 \setbox2=\vbox{}%
5985 \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
5986 \else
5987 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
5988 \dimen@ii = \dimen@
5989 \splittopskip = \topskip
5990 % Loop until left column is at least as high as the right column.
5992 \vbadness = 10000
5993 \loop
5994 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
5995 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
5996 \ifdim\ht1<\ht3
5997 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
5998 \repeat
6000 % Now the left column is in box 1, and the right column in box 3.
6002 % Check whether the left column has come out higher than the page itself.
6003 % (Note that we have doubled \vsize for the double columns, so
6004 % the actual height of the page is 0.5\vsize).
6005 \ifdim2\ht1>\vsize
6006 % It appears that we have been called upon to balance too much material.
6007 % Output some of it with \doublecolumnout, leaving the rest on the page.
6008 \setbox\PAGE=\box0
6009 \doublecolumnout
6010 \else
6011 % Compare the heights of the two columns.
6012 \ifdim4\ht1>5\ht3
6013 % Column heights are too different, so don't make their bottoms
6014 % flush with each other.
6015 \setbox2=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox3\vfill}%
6016 \setbox0=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox1\vfill}%
6017 \else
6018 % Make column bottoms flush with each other.
6019 \setbox2=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox3\unskip}%
6020 \setbox0=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox1\unskip}%
6022 \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
6027 \catcode`\@ = \other
6030 \message{sectioning,}
6031 % Chapters, sections, etc.
6033 % Let's start with @part.
6034 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
6035 \def\partzzz#1{%
6036 \chapoddpage
6037 \null
6038 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
6039 \begingroup
6040 \noindent \titlefonts\rm #1\par % the text
6041 \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with
6042 \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
6043 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
6044 % This outputs a mark at the end of the page that clears \thischapter
6045 % and \thissection, as is done in \startcontents.
6046 \let\pchapsepmacro\relax
6047 \chapmacro{}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6048 \chapoddpage
6049 \endgroup
6052 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
6053 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
6054 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
6055 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
6056 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
6057 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
6058 \newcount\chapno
6059 \newcount\secno \secno=0
6060 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
6061 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
6063 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
6064 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
6066 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
6067 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
6068 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
6069 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
6071 \def\appendixletter{%
6072 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
6073 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
6074 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
6075 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
6076 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
6077 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
6078 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
6079 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
6080 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
6081 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
6082 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
6083 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
6084 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
6085 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
6086 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
6087 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
6088 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
6089 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
6090 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
6091 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
6092 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
6093 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
6094 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
6095 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
6096 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
6097 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
6098 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
6099 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
6100 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
6101 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
6102 \else\char\the\appendixno
6103 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
6104 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
6106 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
6107 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
6108 % these. @section does likewise.
6109 \def\thischapter{}
6110 \def\thischapternum{}
6111 \def\thischaptername{}
6112 \def\thissection{}
6113 \def\thissectionnum{}
6114 \def\thissectionname{}
6116 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
6117 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
6119 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
6120 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
6121 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
6123 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
6124 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
6125 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
6127 % we only have subsub.
6128 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
6130 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
6131 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
6132 \chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
6134 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
6135 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
6136 \def\chapheadtype{N}
6138 % Choose a heading macro
6139 % #1 is heading type
6140 % #2 is heading level
6141 % #3 is text for heading
6142 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
6143 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
6144 \absseclevel=#2
6145 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
6146 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
6147 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
6148 \absseclevel = 0
6149 \else
6150 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
6151 \absseclevel = 3
6154 % The heading type:
6155 \def\headtype{#1}%
6156 \if \headtype U%
6157 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
6158 \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
6160 \else
6161 % Check for appendix sections:
6162 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
6163 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
6164 \else
6165 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
6166 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
6167 \fi\fi
6169 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
6170 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
6171 \def\headtype{U}%
6172 \else
6173 \chardef\unnlevel = 3
6176 % Now print the heading:
6177 \if \headtype U%
6178 \ifcase\absseclevel
6179 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
6180 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
6181 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
6182 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6184 \else
6185 \if \headtype A%
6186 \ifcase\absseclevel
6187 \appendixzzz{#3}%
6188 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
6189 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
6190 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6192 \else
6193 \ifcase\absseclevel
6194 \chapterzzz{#3}%
6195 \or \seczzz{#3}%
6196 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
6197 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6201 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
6204 % an interface:
6205 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
6206 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
6207 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
6209 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
6210 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
6212 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
6213 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
6214 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
6216 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
6217 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
6218 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
6219 % as an @include file.
6220 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6221 \global\advance\chapno by 1
6223 % Used for \float.
6224 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
6225 \resetallfloatnos
6227 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
6228 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
6229 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
6231 % Write the actual heading.
6232 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
6234 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
6235 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
6236 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
6237 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
6240 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
6242 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
6243 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6244 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
6245 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
6246 \resetallfloatnos
6248 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
6249 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
6250 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
6252 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
6254 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
6255 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
6256 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
6259 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
6260 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
6261 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
6262 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6263 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
6265 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
6266 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
6267 \resetallfloatnos
6269 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
6270 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
6271 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
6272 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
6273 % to be executed, not expanded).
6275 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
6276 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
6277 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
6278 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
6279 % the toc entries.)
6280 \toks0 = {#1}%
6281 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
6283 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
6285 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
6286 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
6287 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
6290 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
6291 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
6292 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
6293 \unnmhead0{#1}%
6294 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
6297 % @top is like @unnumbered.
6298 \let\top\unnumbered
6300 % Sections.
6302 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
6303 \def\seczzz#1{%
6304 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6305 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
6308 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
6309 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
6310 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
6311 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6312 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
6314 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
6316 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
6317 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
6318 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
6319 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6320 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
6323 % Subsections.
6325 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
6326 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
6327 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
6328 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6329 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6332 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
6333 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
6334 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
6335 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6336 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
6337 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6340 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
6341 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
6342 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
6343 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6344 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
6345 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6348 % Subsubsections.
6350 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
6351 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
6352 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
6353 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6354 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
6355 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6358 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
6359 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
6360 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
6361 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6362 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
6363 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6366 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
6367 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
6368 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
6369 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6370 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
6371 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6374 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
6375 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
6376 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
6377 \let\section = \numberedsec
6378 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
6379 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
6381 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
6383 \def\majorheading{%
6384 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
6385 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
6388 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
6389 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
6390 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
6391 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
6392 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
6395 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
6396 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6397 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6398 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6399 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6400 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6401 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6403 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
6404 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
6405 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
6407 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
6408 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
6410 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
6411 \newskip\chapheadingskip
6413 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
6414 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
6416 % Start a new page
6417 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
6419 % \chapoddpage - start on an odd page for a new chapter
6420 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
6421 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
6422 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
6423 \def\chapoddpage{%
6424 \chappager
6425 \ifodd\pageno \else
6426 \begingroup
6427 \headingsoff
6428 \null
6429 \chappager
6430 \endgroup
6434 \parseargdef\setchapternewpage{\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
6436 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
6437 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
6438 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
6439 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
6441 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
6442 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
6443 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
6444 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
6445 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
6447 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
6448 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
6449 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
6450 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
6451 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
6453 \CHAPPAGon
6455 % \chapmacro - Chapter opening.
6457 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
6458 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
6459 % Not used for @heading series.
6461 % To test against our argument.
6462 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
6463 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
6464 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
6466 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
6467 \expandafter\ifx\thisenv\titlepage\else
6468 \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
6470 % FIXME: \chapmacro is currently called from inside \titlepage when
6471 % \setcontentsaftertitlepage to print the "Table of Contents" heading, but
6472 % this should probably be done by \sectionheading with an option to print
6473 % in chapter size.
6475 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6476 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
6477 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6478 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6479 \gdef\thissection{}}%
6481 \def\temptype{#2}%
6482 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6483 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6484 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
6485 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6486 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6487 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
6488 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6489 \toks0={#1}%
6490 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6491 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6492 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
6493 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
6494 % commands in some of the translations.
6495 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
6496 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6497 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6499 \else
6500 \toks0={#1}%
6501 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6502 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6503 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
6504 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
6505 % commands in some of the translations.
6506 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
6507 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6508 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6510 \fi\fi\fi
6512 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6513 % the preceding space.
6514 \safewhatsit\domark
6516 % Insert the chapter heading break.
6517 \pchapsepmacro
6519 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6520 % between here and the heading.
6521 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
6522 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6523 \domark
6526 \chapfonts \rm
6527 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
6529 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
6530 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
6531 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
6532 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6534 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
6535 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
6536 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6537 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6538 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
6539 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6540 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
6541 \def\toctype{omit}%
6542 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6543 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
6544 \def\toctype{app}%
6545 \else
6546 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
6547 \def\toctype{numchap}%
6548 \fi\fi\fi
6550 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
6551 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
6552 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
6553 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
6555 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
6556 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
6557 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
6558 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
6559 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
6560 \donoderef{#2}%
6562 % Typeset the actual heading.
6563 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
6564 \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
6565 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
6567 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
6568 \nobreak
6571 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
6572 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
6573 \def\centerparameters{%
6574 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
6575 \leftskip = \rightskip
6576 \parfillskip = 0pt
6580 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
6581 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
6583 \newskip\secheadingskip
6584 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
6586 % Subsection titles.
6587 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
6588 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
6590 % Subsubsection titles.
6591 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
6592 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
6595 % Print any size, any type, section title.
6597 % #1 is the text of the title,
6598 % #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
6599 % #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
6600 % #4 is the section number.
6602 \def\seckeyword{sec}
6604 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
6606 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
6607 \def\temptype{#3}%
6609 % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
6610 % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
6611 % dubious), but not the others.
6612 \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
6613 \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
6615 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading
6617 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
6618 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
6620 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6621 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6622 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6623 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6624 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6625 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
6627 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6628 % Don't redefine \thissection.
6629 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6630 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6631 \toks0={#1}%
6632 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6633 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6634 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6635 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6636 % commands in some of the translations.
6637 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6638 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6639 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6642 \else
6643 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6644 \toks0={#1}%
6645 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6646 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6647 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6648 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6649 % commands in some of the translations.
6650 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6651 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6652 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6655 \fi\fi\fi
6657 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
6658 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
6659 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
6660 \par
6662 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6663 % the preceding space.
6664 \safewhatsit\domark
6666 % Insert space above the heading.
6667 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
6669 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6670 % between here and the heading.
6671 \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6672 \domark
6674 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
6675 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6676 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6677 \def\toctype{unn}%
6678 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6679 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6680 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
6681 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
6682 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6683 \def\toctype{omit}%
6684 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
6685 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6686 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6687 \def\toctype{app}%
6688 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6689 \else
6690 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6691 \def\toctype{num}%
6692 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6693 \fi\fi\fi
6695 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
6696 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
6698 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
6699 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
6700 \donoderef{#3}%
6702 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
6703 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
6704 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
6705 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
6706 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
6707 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
6708 \nobreak
6710 % Output the actual section heading.
6711 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
6712 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
6713 \unhbox0 #1}%
6715 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
6716 % Don't allow stretch, though.
6717 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
6719 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
6720 % was followed by glue.
6721 \nobreak
6723 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
6724 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
6725 % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
6726 % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
6727 % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
6728 % obscuring the section heading with something else.
6729 \vskip-\parskip
6731 % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
6732 % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
6733 % and do the needful.
6734 \penalty 10001
6738 \message{toc,}
6739 % Table of contents.
6740 \newwrite\tocfile
6742 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
6743 % Called from @chapter, etc.
6745 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
6746 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
6747 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
6748 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
6749 % destination to jump to.
6751 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
6752 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
6753 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
6754 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
6756 \newif\iftocfileopened
6757 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
6759 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
6760 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
6761 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
6762 \iftocfileopened\else
6763 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
6764 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
6767 \iflinks
6768 {\atdummies
6769 \edef\temp{%
6770 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
6771 \temp
6776 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
6777 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
6778 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
6779 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
6780 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
6781 % `1', and two named `2'.
6782 \ifpdf
6783 \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
6784 \else
6785 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
6786 \else
6787 \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
6793 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
6794 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
6795 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
6797 \def\activecatcodes{%
6798 \catcode`\"=\active
6799 \catcode`\$=\active
6800 \catcode`\<=\active
6801 \catcode`\>=\active
6802 \catcode`\\=\active
6803 \catcode`\^=\active
6804 \catcode`\_=\active
6805 \catcode`\|=\active
6806 \catcode`\~=\active
6810 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
6811 \def\readtocfile{%
6812 \setupdatafile
6813 \activecatcodes
6814 \input \tocreadfilename
6817 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
6818 \newcount\savepageno
6819 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
6821 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
6823 \def\startcontents#1{%
6824 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
6825 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
6826 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
6827 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
6828 \contentsalignmacro
6829 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
6831 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
6832 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
6833 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6835 \savepageno = \pageno
6836 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
6837 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
6838 \entryrightmargin=\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
6840 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
6841 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
6844 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
6845 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
6847 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
6849 % Normal (long) toc.
6851 \def\contents{%
6852 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
6853 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6854 \ifeof 1 \else
6855 \readtocfile
6857 \vfill \eject
6858 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6859 \ifeof 1 \else
6860 \pdfmakeoutlines
6862 \closein 1
6863 \endgroup
6864 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6865 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6868 % And just the chapters.
6869 \def\summarycontents{%
6870 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
6872 \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
6873 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
6874 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
6875 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
6876 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
6877 \secfonts
6878 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
6879 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
6881 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
6882 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
6883 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
6884 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
6885 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
6886 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6887 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6888 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6889 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6890 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6891 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6892 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6893 \ifeof 1 \else
6894 \readtocfile
6896 \closein 1
6897 \vfill \eject
6898 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6899 \endgroup
6900 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6901 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6903 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
6905 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
6906 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
6908 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
6909 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
6910 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
6911 % But use \hss just in case.
6912 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
6913 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
6915 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
6916 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
6917 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
6918 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
6919 % there are before deciding ...
6920 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
6923 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
6924 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
6925 % The last argument is the page number.
6926 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
6928 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
6929 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
6930 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
6931 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
6932 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{%
6933 % Add stretch and a bonus for breaking the page before the part heading.
6934 % This reduces the chance of the page being broken immediately after the
6935 % part heading, before a following chapter heading.
6936 \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
6937 \penalty-300
6938 \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
6939 \dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}%
6942 % Parts, in the short toc.
6943 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
6944 \penalty-300
6945 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
6946 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
6949 % Chapters, in the main contents.
6950 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6952 % Chapters, in the short toc.
6953 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
6954 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
6955 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
6958 % Appendices, in the main contents.
6959 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
6961 \def\appendixbox#1{%
6962 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
6963 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
6964 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
6966 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\hskip.7em#1}{#4}}
6968 % Unnumbered chapters.
6969 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
6970 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
6972 % Sections.
6973 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6974 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
6975 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
6977 % Subsections.
6978 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6979 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
6980 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6982 % And subsubsections.
6983 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6984 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
6985 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6987 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
6988 % Same as \defaultparindent.
6989 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
6991 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
6992 % page number.
6994 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
6995 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
6996 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
6997 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
6998 \begingroup
6999 % Move the page numbers slightly to the right
7000 \advance\entryrightmargin by -0.05em
7001 \chapentryfonts
7002 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7003 \endgroup
7004 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
7007 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7008 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
7009 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7010 \endgroup}
7012 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7013 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
7014 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7015 \endgroup}
7017 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7018 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
7019 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7020 \endgroup}
7022 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
7023 \let\tocentry = \entry
7025 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
7026 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
7028 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
7029 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
7031 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
7032 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
7033 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
7034 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
7037 \message{environments,}
7038 % @foo ... @end foo.
7040 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
7041 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
7042 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
7044 \envdef\tex{%
7045 \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
7046 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
7047 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
7048 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
7049 \catcode `\%=14
7050 \catcode `\+=\other
7051 \catcode `\"=\other
7052 \catcode `\|=\other
7053 \catcode `\<=\other
7054 \catcode `\>=\other
7055 \catcode `\`=\other
7056 \catcode `\'=\other
7058 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
7059 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
7060 \mathactive
7062 % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
7063 \let\b=\ptexb
7064 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
7065 \let\c=\ptexc
7066 \let\,=\ptexcomma
7067 \let\.=\ptexdot
7068 \let\dots=\ptexdots
7069 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
7070 \let\!=\ptexexclam
7071 \let\i=\ptexi
7072 \let\indent=\ptexindent
7073 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
7074 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
7075 \let\+=\tabalign
7076 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
7077 \let\/=\ptexslash
7078 \let\sp=\ptexsp
7079 \let\*=\ptexstar
7080 %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
7081 \let\t=\ptext
7082 \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer
7083 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
7085 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
7086 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
7087 \def\@{@}%
7089 % There is no need to define \Etex.
7091 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
7092 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
7093 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
7095 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
7096 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
7098 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
7099 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
7100 % have any width.
7101 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
7103 % This space is always present above and below environments.
7104 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
7106 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
7107 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
7108 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
7109 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
7111 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
7112 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
7113 % \sectionheading, q.v.
7114 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
7115 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
7116 \endgraf
7117 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
7118 \removelastskip
7119 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
7120 % Penalize breaking before the environment, because preceding text
7121 % often leads into it.
7122 \penalty100
7124 \vskip\envskipamount
7129 \def\afterenvbreak{{%
7130 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
7131 % \sectionheading, q.v.
7132 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
7133 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
7134 \endgraf
7135 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
7136 \removelastskip
7137 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
7138 % or better ...
7139 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
7140 \vskip\envskipamount
7145 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
7146 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
7147 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
7149 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
7150 % environment contents.
7151 \font\circle=lcircle10
7152 \newdimen\circthick
7153 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
7154 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
7155 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
7157 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
7158 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
7159 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
7160 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
7161 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
7162 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
7163 \hskip\rskip}}
7164 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
7165 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
7166 \hskip\rskip}}
7168 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
7170 \envdef\cartouche{%
7171 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
7172 \startsavinginserts
7173 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
7174 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
7175 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
7176 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
7177 \cartouter=\hsize
7178 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
7179 % side, and for 6pt waste from
7180 % each corner char, and rule thickness
7181 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
7183 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
7184 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
7185 % collide with the section heading.
7186 \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
7188 \setbox\groupbox=\vbox\bgroup
7189 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
7190 \carttop
7191 \hbox\bgroup
7192 \hskip\lskip
7193 \vrule\kern3pt
7194 \vbox\bgroup
7195 \kern3pt
7196 \hsize=\cartinner
7197 \baselineskip=\normbskip
7198 \lineskip=\normlskip
7199 \parskip=\normpskip
7200 \vskip -\parskip
7201 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
7203 \def\Ecartouche{%
7204 \ifhmode\par\fi
7205 \kern3pt
7206 \egroup
7207 \kern3pt\vrule
7208 \hskip\rskip
7209 \egroup
7210 \cartbot
7211 \egroup
7212 \addgroupbox
7213 \checkinserts
7217 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
7218 % inside a group.
7219 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
7220 \def\nonfillstart{%
7221 \aboveenvbreak
7222 \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
7223 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
7224 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
7225 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
7226 \parskip = 0pt
7227 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
7228 % the normal \indent.
7229 \nonfillparindent=\parindent
7230 \parindent = 0pt
7231 \let\indent\nonfillindent
7233 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
7234 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7235 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
7236 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
7237 \else
7238 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
7240 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
7243 \begingroup
7244 \obeyspaces
7245 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
7246 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
7247 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
7248 % @indent.
7249 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
7250 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
7251 \ifx\temp %
7252 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
7253 \else%
7254 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
7255 \fi%
7257 \endgroup
7258 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
7259 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
7261 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
7262 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
7263 % This affects the following displayed environments:
7264 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
7266 \def\smallword{small}
7267 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
7268 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
7269 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
7270 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
7271 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
7272 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
7273 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
7274 % to change the fonts afterward.
7275 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
7276 \smallexamplefonts \rm
7279 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
7280 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
7281 \else
7282 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
7283 \smallexamplefonts \rm
7287 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
7288 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
7289 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
7290 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
7291 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
7292 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
7293 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
7296 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
7297 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
7298 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
7299 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
7302 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
7303 % @example: same as @lisp.
7305 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
7306 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
7308 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
7309 \nonfillstart
7310 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
7311 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
7312 \gobble % eat return
7314 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
7316 \makedispenvdef{display}{%
7317 \nonfillstart
7318 \gobble
7321 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
7323 \makedispenvdef{format}{%
7324 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7325 \nonfillstart
7326 \gobble
7329 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
7330 \envdef\flushleft{%
7331 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7332 \nonfillstart
7333 \gobble
7335 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
7337 % @flushright.
7339 \envdef\flushright{%
7340 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7341 \nonfillstart
7342 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
7343 \gobble
7345 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
7348 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
7349 % justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special
7350 % characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right
7351 % should be enough.
7352 \envdef\raggedright{%
7353 \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
7354 \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt}%
7355 \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt}%
7357 \let\Eraggedright\par
7359 \envdef\raggedleft{%
7360 \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
7361 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
7362 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
7363 % badness reporting.
7365 \let\Eraggedleft\par
7367 \envdef\raggedcenter{%
7368 \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
7369 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
7370 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
7371 % badness reporting.
7373 \let\Eraggedcenter\par
7376 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
7377 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
7378 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
7379 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
7381 \makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
7383 \def\quotationstart{%
7384 \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
7385 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7386 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
7388 \parsearg\quotationlabel
7391 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
7392 % doing normal filling.
7394 \def\Equotation{%
7395 \par
7396 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
7397 % indent a bit.
7398 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
7400 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
7402 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
7404 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
7405 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
7406 \def\temp{#1}%
7407 \ifx\temp\empty \else
7408 {\bf #1: }%
7412 % @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
7413 % has no optional argument.
7415 \makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
7417 \def\indentedblockstart{%
7418 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
7419 \parindent=0pt
7421 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
7422 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7423 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
7424 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
7425 \else
7426 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
7430 % Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
7432 \def\Eindentedblock{%
7433 \par
7434 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
7436 \def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
7439 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
7440 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
7441 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
7442 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
7444 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
7446 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
7447 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
7448 % verbatim line.
7449 \def\dospecials{%
7450 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
7451 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
7452 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
7453 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
7454 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
7455 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
7456 %\do\`\do\'%
7459 % [Knuth] p. 380
7460 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
7461 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
7463 % Setup for the @verb command.
7465 % Eight spaces for a tab
7466 \begingroup
7467 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7468 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
7469 \endgroup
7471 \def\setupverb{%
7472 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7473 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
7474 \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
7475 \tabeightspaces
7476 % Respect line breaks,
7477 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7478 % make each space count
7479 % must do in this order:
7480 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7483 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
7485 % Real tab expansion.
7486 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
7488 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
7489 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
7490 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
7491 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
7492 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
7493 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
7494 \newbox\verbbox
7495 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
7497 \begingroup
7498 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7499 \gdef\tabexpand{%
7500 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7501 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
7502 \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
7503 \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
7504 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
7505 \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
7506 \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
7509 \endgroup
7511 % start the verbatim environment.
7512 \def\setupverbatim{%
7513 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7514 \nonfillstart
7515 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7516 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
7517 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
7518 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
7519 \tabexpand
7520 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
7521 % Respect line breaks,
7522 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7523 % make each space count.
7524 % Must do in this order:
7525 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7526 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
7529 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
7530 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
7531 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
7533 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
7535 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
7536 \begingroup
7537 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
7538 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
7539 \endgroup
7541 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
7544 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
7545 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
7547 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
7549 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
7550 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
7551 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
7553 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
7555 \begingroup
7556 \catcode`\ =\active
7557 \obeylines %
7558 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
7559 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
7560 % line in the output.
7561 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
7562 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
7563 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
7564 \endgroup
7566 \envdef\verbatim{%
7567 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
7569 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
7572 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
7574 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
7576 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
7578 \makevalueexpandable
7579 \setupverbatim
7580 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
7581 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
7582 \input #1
7583 \afterenvbreak
7587 % @copying ... @end copying.
7588 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
7590 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
7591 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
7592 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
7593 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
7594 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
7595 % possible is desirable.
7597 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
7598 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
7600 \def\insertcopying{%
7601 \begingroup
7602 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
7603 \scanexp\copyingtext
7604 \endgroup
7608 \message{defuns,}
7609 % @defun etc.
7611 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
7612 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
7613 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
7614 \newcount\defunpenalty
7616 % Start the processing of @deffn:
7617 \def\startdefun{%
7618 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
7619 \medbreak
7620 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
7621 % following @def command, see below.
7622 \else
7623 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
7624 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
7625 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
7626 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
7627 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
7628 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
7629 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
7631 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
7632 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
7633 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
7634 % @def command.
7635 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
7637 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
7638 % But do insert the glue.
7639 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
7642 \parindent=0in
7643 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
7644 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7647 \def\dodefunx#1{%
7648 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
7649 \checkenv#1%
7651 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
7652 % It's not a great place, though.
7653 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
7655 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
7656 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
7658 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
7660 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
7662 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
7663 \begingroup
7664 % call \deffnheader:
7665 #1#2 \endheader
7666 % common ending:
7667 \interlinepenalty = 10000
7668 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
7669 \endgraf
7670 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
7671 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
7672 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
7673 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
7674 \checkparencounts
7675 \endgroup
7678 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
7680 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
7681 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
7683 \def\makedefun#1{%
7684 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
7685 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
7686 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
7687 \temp
7690 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader { (defn. of \deffnheader) }
7692 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
7693 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
7695 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
7696 \envdef#1{%
7697 \startdefun
7698 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
7699 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
7701 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
7702 \def#3%
7705 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
7706 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
7708 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
7709 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
7710 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
7712 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
7713 \def\temp{#1}%
7714 \ifx\temp\onword
7715 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
7716 = \empty
7717 \else\ifx\temp\offword
7718 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
7719 = \relax
7720 \else
7721 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7722 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
7723 must be on|off}%
7724 \fi\fi
7727 % Untyped functions:
7729 % @deffn category name args
7730 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
7732 % @deffn category class name args
7733 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7735 % \defopon {category on}class name args
7736 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7738 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
7740 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
7741 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
7742 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
7743 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
7746 % Typed functions:
7748 % @deftypefn category type name args
7749 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
7751 % @deftypeop category class type name args
7752 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7754 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
7755 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7757 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
7759 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7760 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7761 \doingtypefntrue
7762 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7765 % Typed variables:
7767 % @deftypevr category type var args
7768 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
7770 % @deftypecv category class type var args
7771 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7773 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
7774 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7776 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
7778 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7779 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7780 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7783 % Untyped variables:
7785 % @defvr category var args
7786 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
7788 % @defcv category class var args
7789 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7791 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
7792 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
7794 % Types:
7796 % @deftp category name args
7797 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
7798 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
7799 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
7802 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
7803 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7804 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
7805 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
7806 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7807 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7808 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
7809 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7810 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
7811 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
7812 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7813 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7815 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
7816 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
7817 % #2 is the return type, if any.
7818 % #3 is the function name.
7820 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
7822 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
7823 \par
7824 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
7825 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
7827 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
7828 % on a line by itself.
7829 \rettypeownlinefalse
7830 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
7831 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
7832 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
7833 \rettypeownlinetrue
7837 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
7838 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
7839 % just below it.
7840 \def\temp{#1}%
7841 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
7843 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
7844 % least two.
7845 \tempnum = 2
7847 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
7848 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
7849 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
7851 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
7852 \ifrettypeownline
7853 \advance\tempnum by 1
7854 \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
7855 \else
7856 \def\maybeshapeline{}%
7859 % The continuations:
7860 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
7862 % The final paragraph shape:
7863 \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
7865 % Put the category name at the right margin.
7866 \noindent
7867 \hbox to 0pt{%
7868 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
7869 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
7870 \kern\leftskip
7871 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
7874 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
7875 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
7876 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7878 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
7879 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
7880 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
7881 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
7882 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
7883 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
7884 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
7885 % one has made identifiers using them :).
7886 \df \tt
7887 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
7888 \ifx\temp\empty\else
7889 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
7890 \ifrettypeownline
7891 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
7892 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
7893 \else
7894 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
7896 \fi % no return type
7897 #3% output function name
7899 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \rmfont
7901 \boldbrax
7902 % arguments will be output next, if any.
7905 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
7906 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
7907 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
7908 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
7910 \def\defunargs#1{%
7911 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
7912 % tt for the names.
7913 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
7915 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
7916 % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
7917 % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
7918 % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
7919 % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
7920 \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
7922 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
7925 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
7927 \def\activeparens{%
7928 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
7929 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
7930 \catcode`\&=\active
7933 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
7934 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
7936 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
7937 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
7938 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
7940 \activeparens
7941 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
7942 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
7943 \global\let& = \&
7945 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
7946 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
7948 \let\ampchar\&
7950 \newcount\parencount
7952 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
7953 \newif\ifampseen
7954 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
7956 \def\parenfont{%
7957 \ifampseen
7958 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
7959 % otherwise use the default font.
7960 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
7961 \else
7962 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
7963 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
7967 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
7968 \ifampseen
7969 \ifnum\parencount=1
7974 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
7976 \def\opnr{%
7977 \global\advance\parencount by 1
7978 {\parenfont(}%
7979 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
7981 \def\clnr{%
7982 {\parenfont)}%
7983 \infirstlevel \sl
7984 \global\advance\parencount by -1
7987 \newcount\brackcount
7988 \def\lbrb{%
7989 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
7990 {\bf[}%
7992 \def\rbrb{%
7993 {\bf]}%
7994 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
7997 \def\checkparencounts{%
7998 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
7999 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
8001 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
8002 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
8003 \def\badparencount{%
8004 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
8005 \global\parencount=0
8007 \def\badbrackcount{%
8008 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
8009 \global\brackcount=0
8013 \message{macros,}
8014 % @macro.
8016 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
8017 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
8018 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
8019 \newwrite\macscribble
8020 \def\scantokens#1{%
8021 \toks0={#1}%
8022 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
8023 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
8024 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
8025 \input \jobname.tmp
8029 % alias because \c means cedilla in @tex or @math
8030 \let\texinfoc=\c
8032 \newcount\savedcatcodeone
8033 \newcount\savedcatcodetwo
8035 % Used at the time of macro expansion.
8036 % Argument is macro body with arguments substituted
8037 \def\scanmacro#1{%
8038 \newlinechar`\^^M
8039 \def\xeatspaces{\eatspaces}%
8041 % Temporarily undo catcode changes of \printindex. Set catcode of @ to
8042 % 0 so that @-commands in macro expansions aren't printed literally when
8043 % formatting an index file, where \ is used as the escape character.
8044 \savedcatcodeone=\catcode`\@
8045 \savedcatcodetwo=\catcode`\\
8046 \catcode`\@=0
8047 \catcode`\\=\active
8049 % Process the macro body under the current catcode regime.
8050 \scantokens{#1@texinfoc}%
8052 \catcode`\@=\savedcatcodeone
8053 \catcode`\\=\savedcatcodetwo
8055 % The \texinfoc is to remove the \newlinechar added by \scantokens, and
8056 % can be noticed by \parsearg.
8057 % We avoid surrounding the call to \scantokens with \bgroup and \egroup
8058 % to allow macros to open or close groups themselves.
8061 % Used for copying and captions
8062 \def\scanexp#1{%
8063 \expandafter\scanmacro\expandafter{#1}%
8066 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
8067 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
8068 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
8070 % List of all defined macros in the form
8071 % \commondummyword\macro1\commondummyword\macro2...
8072 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
8073 % if there is a need.
8074 \def\macrolist{}
8076 % Add the macro to \macrolist
8077 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
8078 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
8079 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\commondummyword#1}%
8080 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
8083 % Utility routines.
8084 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
8085 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
8086 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
8088 \def\cslet#1#2{%
8089 \expandafter\let
8090 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
8091 \csname#2\endcsname
8094 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
8095 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
8096 {\catcode`\@=11
8097 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
8098 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
8099 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
8100 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
8101 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
8104 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
8105 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
8106 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
8107 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
8108 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
8111 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
8112 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
8113 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
8114 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
8116 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
8117 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
8118 % confine the change to the current group.
8120 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
8121 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
8122 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
8124 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
8125 \catcode`\"=\other
8126 \catcode`\+=\other
8127 \catcode`\<=\other
8128 \catcode`\>=\other
8129 \catcode`\^=\other
8130 \catcode`\_=\other
8131 \catcode`\|=\other
8132 \catcode`\~=\other
8133 \passthroughcharstrue
8136 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
8137 \scanctxt
8138 \catcode`\@=\other
8139 \catcode`\\=\other
8140 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8143 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
8144 \scanctxt
8145 \catcode`\ =\other
8146 \catcode`\@=\other
8147 \catcode`\{=\other
8148 \catcode`\}=\other
8149 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8150 \usembodybackslash
8153 % Used when scanning braced macro arguments. Note, however, that catcode
8154 % changes here are ineffectual if the macro invocation was nested inside
8155 % an argument to another Texinfo command.
8156 \def\macroargctxt{%
8157 \scanctxt
8158 \catcode`\ =\active
8159 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8160 \catcode`\\=\active
8163 \def\macrolineargctxt{% used for whole-line arguments without braces
8164 \scanctxt
8165 \catcode`\{=\other
8166 \catcode`\}=\other
8169 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
8170 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
8171 % where N is the macro parameter number.
8172 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
8173 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
8175 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
8176 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
8177 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
8179 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
8181 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
8183 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
8184 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
8186 \def\macroxxx#1{%
8187 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
8188 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
8189 \paramno=0\relax
8190 \else
8191 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
8192 \if\paramno>256\relax
8193 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
8194 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8195 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
8199 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
8200 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
8201 \else
8202 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
8203 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
8204 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
8205 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
8206 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
8208 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
8209 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
8210 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
8211 \fi}
8213 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
8214 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
8215 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
8216 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
8217 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
8218 \begingroup
8219 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
8220 \let\commondummyword\unmacrodo
8221 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
8222 \endgroup
8223 \else
8224 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
8228 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
8229 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
8231 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
8232 \ifx #1\relax
8233 % remove this
8234 \else
8235 \noexpand\commondummyword \noexpand#1%
8239 % \getargs -- Parse the arguments to a @macro line. Set \macname to
8240 % the name of the macro, and \argl to the braced argument list.
8241 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
8242 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
8243 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
8244 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
8245 % This made use of the feature that if the last token of a
8246 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
8247 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
8249 % Parse the optional {params} list to @macro or @rmacro.
8250 % Set \paramno to the number of arguments,
8251 % and \paramlist to a parameter text for the macro (e.g. #1,#2,#3 for a
8252 % three-param macro.) Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH in the params
8253 % list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If there are
8254 % less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
8255 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
8256 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
8258 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
8260 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used: see
8261 % \parsemmanyargdef.
8263 \def\parsemargdef#1;{%
8264 \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
8265 \let\hash\relax
8266 % \hash is redefined to `#' later to get it into definitions
8267 \let\xeatspaces\relax
8268 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
8269 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
8270 \paramno0\relax
8271 \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
8274 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
8275 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
8276 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
8277 \advance\paramno by 1
8278 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
8279 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
8280 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
8281 \fi\next}
8283 % \parsemacbody, \parsermacbody
8285 % Read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. (They're different since
8286 % rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
8288 % We are in \macrobodyctxt, and the \xdef causes backslashshes in the macro
8289 % body to be transformed.
8290 % Set \macrobody to the body of the macro, and call \defmacro.
8292 {\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsemacbody#1@end macro{%
8293 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
8294 {\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro{%
8295 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
8297 % Make @ a letter, so that we can make private-to-Texinfo macro names.
8298 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
8299 \catcode `@=11\relax
8301 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% Code for > 10 arguments only %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8303 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
8304 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
8305 % processed again to replace the arguments.
8307 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
8308 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
8309 % the catcode regime under which the body was input).
8311 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
8312 % arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
8314 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
8315 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
8316 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
8317 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
8318 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
8319 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
8320 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
8321 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
8322 \else
8323 \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
8324 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
8325 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
8326 \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
8327 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
8328 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
8329 % \xdef .
8330 \expandafter\edef\tempa
8331 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
8332 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
8333 \fi\next}
8336 \let\endargs@\relax
8337 \let\nil@\relax
8338 \def\nilm@{\nil@}%
8339 \long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
8341 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
8342 % definition. It gets all the arguments' values and assigns them to macros
8343 % macarg.ARGNAME
8345 % #1 is the macro name
8346 % #2 is the list of argument names
8347 % #3 is the list of argument values
8348 \def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
8349 \def\macargdeflist@{}%
8350 \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
8351 \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
8352 \def\macroname{#1}%
8353 \begingroup
8354 \macroargctxt
8355 \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
8356 \def\@tempa{#3}%
8357 \ifx\@tempa\empty
8358 \setemptyargvalues@
8359 \else
8360 \getargvals@@
8363 \def\getargvals@@{%
8364 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
8365 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
8366 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
8367 \else
8368 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8369 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
8371 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
8372 \else
8373 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
8374 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
8375 % macros to empty.
8376 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
8377 \else
8378 % pop current arg name into \@tempb
8379 \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
8380 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
8381 % pop current argument value into \@tempc
8382 \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
8383 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
8384 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
8385 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
8386 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
8387 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
8388 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
8389 \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
8390 \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
8391 \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
8392 \let\next\getargvals@@
8395 \next
8398 \def\push@#1#2{%
8399 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
8400 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
8401 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
8402 \expandafter#1#2}%
8405 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
8406 % in macro \@tempa.
8408 \def\macvalstoargs@{%
8409 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
8410 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
8411 % values into respective token registers.
8413 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
8414 \begingroup
8415 \paramno0\relax
8416 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
8417 % value into a new token list register \toks#N
8418 \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
8419 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
8420 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
8421 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
8422 \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
8423 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
8424 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
8425 % group.
8426 \expandafter
8427 \endgroup
8428 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
8431 % Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
8433 \def\macargexpandinbody@{%
8434 \expandafter
8435 \endgroup
8436 \macargdeflist@
8437 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
8438 % is in \@tempa .
8439 \macvalstoargs@
8440 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
8441 % with \@tempb .
8442 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
8443 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
8444 % \egroup .
8445 \ifx\@tempb\gobble
8446 \let\@tempc\relax
8447 \else
8448 \let\@tempc\egroup
8450 % And now we do the real job:
8451 \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
8452 \@tempd
8455 \def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
8456 \if#1;\let\next\relax
8457 \else
8458 \let\next\putargsintokens@
8459 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
8460 % alias \@tempb .
8461 \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
8462 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
8463 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
8464 \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
8465 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
8467 \next
8470 % Trailing missing arguments are set to empty.
8472 \def\setemptyargvalues@{%
8473 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
8474 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
8475 \else
8476 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
8477 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
8479 \next
8482 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
8483 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
8484 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
8485 \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
8486 \def\paramlist{#2}%
8489 % #1 is the element target macro
8490 % #2 is the list macro
8491 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
8492 \def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
8493 \def#1{#3}%
8494 \def#2{#4}%
8496 \long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
8497 \long\def#1{#3}%
8498 \long\def#2{#4}%
8502 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% End of code for > 10 arguments %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8505 % This defines a Texinfo @macro or @rmacro, called by \parsemacbody.
8506 % \macrobody has the body of the macro in it, with placeholders for
8507 % its parameters, looking like "\xeatspaces{\hash 1}".
8508 % \paramno is the number of parameters
8509 % \paramlist is a TeX parameter text, e.g. "#1,#2,#3,"
8510 % There are four cases: macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
8511 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
8512 % they're defined in: @include reads the file inside a group.
8514 \def\defmacro{%
8515 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
8516 \ifnum\paramno=1
8517 \def\xeatspaces##1{##1}%
8518 % This removes the pair of braces around the argument. We don't
8519 % use \eatspaces, because this can cause ends of lines to be lost
8520 % when the argument to \eatspaces is read, leading to line-based
8521 % commands like "@itemize" not being read correctly.
8522 \else
8523 \let\xeatspaces\relax % suppress expansion
8525 \ifcase\paramno
8527 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8528 \bgroup
8529 \noexpand\spaceisspace
8530 \noexpand\endlineisspace
8531 \noexpand\expandafter % skip any whitespace after the macro name.
8532 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
8533 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{%
8534 \egroup
8535 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8536 \or % 1
8537 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8538 \bgroup
8539 \noexpand\braceorline
8540 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
8541 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
8542 \egroup
8543 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
8545 \else % at most 9
8546 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
8547 % @MACNAME sets the context for reading the macro argument
8548 % @MACNAME@@ gets the argument, processes backslashes and appends a
8549 % comma.
8550 % @MACNAME@@@ removes braces surrounding the argument list.
8551 % @MACNAME@@@@ scans the macro body with arguments substituted.
8552 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8553 \bgroup
8554 \noexpand\expandafter % This \expandafter skip any spaces after the
8555 \noexpand\macroargctxt % macro before we change the catcode of space.
8556 \noexpand\expandafter
8557 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname}%
8558 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname##1{%
8559 \noexpand\passargtomacro
8560 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{##1,}}%
8561 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
8562 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname ##1}%
8563 \expandafter\expandafter
8564 \expandafter\xdef
8565 \expandafter\expandafter
8566 \csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname\paramlist{%
8567 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8568 \else % 10 or more:
8569 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8570 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
8572 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\macrobody
8573 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
8575 \fi}
8577 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax % end private-to-Texinfo catcodes
8579 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
8582 %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8584 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=13 % We need to manipulate \ so use @ as escape
8585 @catcode`@_=11 % private names
8586 @catcode`@!=11 % used as argument separator
8588 % \passargtomacro#1#2 -
8589 % Call #1 with a list of tokens #2, with any doubled backslashes in #2
8590 % compressed to one.
8592 % This implementation works by expansion, and not execution (so we cannot use
8593 % \def or similar). This reduces the risk of this failing in contexts where
8594 % complete expansion is done with no execution (for example, in writing out to
8595 % an auxiliary file for an index entry).
8597 % State is kept in the input stream: the argument passed to
8598 % @look_ahead, @gobble_and_check_finish and @add_segment is
8600 % THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT ! {PENDING_BS} NEXT_TOKEN (... rest of input)
8602 % where:
8603 % THE_MACRO - name of the macro we want to call
8604 % ARG_RESULT - argument list we build to pass to that macro
8605 % PENDING_BS - either a backslash or nothing
8606 % NEXT_TOKEN - used to look ahead in the input stream to see what's coming next
8608 @gdef@passargtomacro#1#2{%
8609 @add_segment #1!{}@relax#2\@_finish\%
8611 @gdef@_finish{@_finishx} @global@let@_finishx@relax
8613 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8614 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8615 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8616 % #4 used to look ahead
8618 % If the next token is not a backslash, process the rest of the argument;
8619 % otherwise, remove the next token.
8620 @gdef@look_ahead#1!#2#3#4{%
8621 @ifx#4\%
8622 @expandafter@gobble_and_check_finish
8623 @else
8624 @expandafter@add_segment
8625 @fi#1!{#2}#4#4%
8628 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8629 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8630 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8631 % #4 should be a backslash, which is gobbled.
8632 % #5 looks ahead
8634 % Double backslash found. Add a single backslash, and look ahead.
8635 @gdef@gobble_and_check_finish#1!#2#3#4#5{%
8636 @add_segment#1\!{}#5#5%
8639 @gdef@is_fi{@fi}
8641 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8642 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8643 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8644 % #4 is input stream until next backslash
8646 % Input stream is either at the start of the argument, or just after a
8647 % backslash sequence, either a lone backslash, or a doubled backslash.
8648 % NEXT_TOKEN contains the first token in the input stream: if it is \finish,
8649 % finish; otherwise, append to ARG_RESULT the segment of the argument up until
8650 % the next backslash. PENDING_BACKSLASH contains a backslash to represent
8651 % a backslash just before the start of the input stream that has not been
8652 % added to ARG_RESULT.
8653 @gdef@add_segment#1!#2#3#4\{%
8654 @ifx#3@_finish
8655 @call_the_macro#1!%
8656 @else
8657 % append the pending backslash to the result, followed by the next segment
8658 @expandafter@is_fi@look_ahead#1#2#4!{\}@fi
8659 % this @fi is discarded by @look_ahead.
8660 % we can't get rid of it with \expandafter because we don't know how
8661 % long #4 is.
8664 % #1 - THE_MACRO
8665 % #2 - ARG_RESULT
8666 % #3 discards the res of the conditional in @add_segment, and @is_fi ends the
8667 % conditional.
8668 @gdef@call_the_macro#1#2!#3@fi{@is_fi #1{#2}}
8671 %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8673 % \braceorline MAC is used for a one-argument macro MAC. It checks
8674 % whether the next non-whitespace character is a {. It sets the context
8675 % for reading the argument (slightly different in the two cases). Then,
8676 % to read the argument, in the whole-line case, it then calls the regular
8677 % \parsearg MAC; in the lbrace case, it calls \passargtomacro MAC.
8679 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
8680 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
8681 \ifx\nchar\bgroup
8682 \macroargctxt
8683 \expandafter\passargtomacro
8684 \else
8685 \macrolineargctxt\expandafter\parsearg
8686 \fi \macnamexxx}
8689 % @alias.
8690 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
8691 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
8693 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
8694 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
8695 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
8697 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
8698 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
8699 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
8701 \next
8705 \message{cross references,}
8707 \newwrite\auxfile
8708 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
8709 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
8711 % @inforef is relatively simple.
8712 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
8713 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
8714 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
8715 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
8717 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
8718 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
8719 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
8720 % @node foo , bar , ...
8721 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
8723 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
8725 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
8726 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
8727 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
8728 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
8730 \let\nwnode=\node
8731 \let\lastnode=\empty
8733 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
8734 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
8736 \def\donoderef#1{%
8737 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
8738 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
8739 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
8743 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
8745 \newcount\savesfregister
8747 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
8748 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
8749 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
8751 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
8752 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
8753 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
8754 % or the anchor name.
8755 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
8756 % empty for anchors.
8757 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
8759 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
8760 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
8761 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
8763 \def\setref#1#2{%
8764 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
8765 \iflinks
8767 \requireauxfile
8768 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
8769 % match definition in \xrdef, \refx, \xrefX.
8770 \def\value##1{##1}%
8771 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
8772 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
8773 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
8775 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
8776 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
8777 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
8778 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
8783 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
8784 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
8785 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
8786 % variable, now it's official.
8788 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
8789 \def\temp{#1}%
8790 \ifx\temp\onword
8791 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
8792 = \empty
8793 \else\ifx\temp\offword
8794 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
8795 = \relax
8796 \else
8797 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8798 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
8799 must be on|off}%
8800 \fi\fi
8803 % \f
8804 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
8805 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
8806 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
8807 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
8809 \def\pxref{\putwordsee{} \xrefXX}
8810 \def\xref{\putwordSee{} \xrefXX}
8811 \def\ref{\xrefXX}
8813 \def\xrefXX#1{\def\xrefXXarg{#1}\futurelet\tokenafterxref\xrefXXX}
8814 \def\xrefXXX{\expandafter\xrefX\expandafter[\xrefXXarg,,,,,,,]}
8816 \newbox\toprefbox
8817 \newbox\printedrefnamebox
8818 \newbox\infofilenamebox
8819 \newbox\printedmanualbox
8821 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
8822 \unsepspaces
8824 % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
8825 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
8826 \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
8828 \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
8829 \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
8831 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
8832 \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
8834 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
8835 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
8836 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8837 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
8838 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
8839 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
8840 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8841 \else
8842 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
8843 % the square brackets if we have it.
8844 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8845 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
8846 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8847 \else
8848 \ifhavexrefs
8849 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
8850 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
8851 \else
8852 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
8853 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8854 \fi%
8859 % Make link in pdf output.
8860 \ifpdf
8861 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
8862 {\indexnofonts
8863 \makevalueexpandable
8864 \turnoffactive
8865 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8866 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8867 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8868 \getfilename{#4}%
8870 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8871 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8872 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
8874 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
8875 \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
8878 \leavevmode
8879 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
8880 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8881 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfdestname}%
8882 \else
8883 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}%
8886 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8887 \else
8888 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
8889 \else
8890 % For XeTeX
8891 {\indexnofonts
8892 \makevalueexpandable
8893 \turnoffactive
8894 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8895 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8896 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8897 \getfilename{#4}%
8899 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8900 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8901 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
8903 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
8904 \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
8907 \leavevmode
8908 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8909 % With default settings,
8910 % XeTeX (xdvipdfmx) replaces link destination names with integers.
8911 % In this case, the replaced destination names of
8912 % remote PDFs are no longer known. In order to avoid a replacement,
8913 % you can use xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
8914 % If you use XeTeX 0.99996+ (TeX Live 2016+),
8915 % this command line option is no longer necessary
8916 % because we can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special.
8917 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
8918 << /S /GoToR /F (\the\filename.pdf) /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
8919 \else
8920 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
8921 << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
8924 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8928 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
8929 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
8930 \indexnofonts
8931 \turnoffactive
8932 \def\value##1{##1}%
8933 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
8934 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
8937 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
8938 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". \iffloat distinguishes them by
8939 % \Xthisreftitle being set to a magic string.
8940 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
8941 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
8942 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
8943 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8944 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
8945 \else
8946 \printedrefname
8949 % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
8950 % "in MANUALNAME".
8951 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8952 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
8954 \else
8955 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
8957 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
8958 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
8959 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
8960 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
8961 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
8962 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
8964 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8965 % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
8967 \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
8969 \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
8970 % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
8971 % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
8972 % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
8974 \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
8976 \else
8977 % Reference within this manual.
8979 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
8980 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
8981 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
8982 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
8983 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
8984 {\turnoffactive
8985 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
8986 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
8987 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
8988 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
8990 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
8991 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
8993 % But we always want a comma and a space:
8994 ,\space
8996 % output the `page 3'.
8997 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
8998 % Add a , if xref followed by a space
8999 \if\space\noexpand\tokenafterxref ,%
9000 \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @TAB
9001 \else\ifx\*\tokenafterxref ,% @*
9002 \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @SPACE
9003 \else\ifx\
9004 \tokenafterxref ,% @NL
9005 \else\ifx\tie\tokenafterxref ,% @tie
9006 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
9007 \fi\fi
9009 \endlink
9010 \endgroup}
9012 % Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
9014 % Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
9015 % missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
9016 % "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
9018 % But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
9019 % string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
9020 % the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
9021 % likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
9022 % in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
9024 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
9025 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
9027 \def\crossmanualxref#1{%
9028 \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
9029 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
9030 \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty?
9031 \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
9032 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
9038 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
9039 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
9040 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
9041 % one that Bob is working on :).
9043 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
9045 % Things referred to by \setref.
9047 \def\Ynothing{}
9048 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
9049 \def\Ynumbered{%
9050 \ifnum\secno=0
9051 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
9052 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
9053 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
9054 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
9055 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
9056 \else
9057 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
9058 \fi\fi\fi
9060 \def\Yappendix{%
9061 \ifnum\secno=0
9062 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
9063 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
9064 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
9065 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
9066 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
9067 \else
9068 \putwordSection@tie
9069 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
9070 \fi\fi\fi
9073 % \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} - reference a cross-reference string named NAME. SUFFIX
9074 % is output afterwards if non-empty.
9075 \def\refx#1#2{%
9076 \requireauxfile
9078 \indexnofonts
9079 \otherbackslash
9080 \def\value##1{##1}%
9081 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
9082 \csname XR#1\endcsname
9084 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
9085 % If not defined, say something at least.
9086 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
9087 \iflinks
9088 \ifhavexrefs
9089 {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
9090 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
9091 \else
9092 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
9093 \global\warnedxrefstrue
9094 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
9098 \else
9099 % It's defined, so just use it.
9100 \thisrefX
9102 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
9105 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Define a control
9106 % sequence for a cross-reference target (we prepend XR to the control sequence
9107 % name to avoid collisions). The value is the page number. If this is a float
9108 % type, we have more work to do.
9110 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
9111 {% Expand the node or anchor name to remove control sequences.
9112 % \turnoffactive stops 8-bit characters being changed to commands
9113 % like @'e. \refx does the same to retrieve the value in the definition.
9114 \indexnofonts
9115 \turnoffactive
9116 \def\value##1{##1}%
9117 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
9120 \bgroup
9121 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}%
9122 \egroup
9123 % We put the \gdef inside a group to avoid the definitions building up on
9124 % TeX's save stack, which can cause it to run out of space for aux files with
9125 % thousands of lines. \gdef doesn't use the save stack, but \csname does
9126 % when it defines an unknown control sequence as \relax.
9128 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
9129 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
9130 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
9131 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
9132 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
9134 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
9135 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
9136 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
9137 \else
9138 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
9139 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
9142 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
9143 % for later use in \listoffloats.
9144 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
9145 {\safexrefname}}%
9149 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
9150 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
9151 % This is done with @novalidate at the beginning of the file.
9153 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
9154 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
9156 % Used when writing to the aux file, or when using data from it.
9157 \def\requireauxfile{%
9158 \iflinks
9159 \tryauxfile
9160 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
9161 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
9163 \global\let\requireauxfile=\relax % Only do this once.
9166 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
9168 \def\tryauxfile{%
9169 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
9170 \ifeof 1 \else
9171 \readdatafile{aux}%
9172 \global\havexrefstrue
9174 \closein 1
9177 \def\setupdatafile{%
9178 \catcode`\^^@=\other
9179 \catcode`\^^A=\other
9180 \catcode`\^^B=\other
9181 \catcode`\^^C=\other
9182 \catcode`\^^D=\other
9183 \catcode`\^^E=\other
9184 \catcode`\^^F=\other
9185 \catcode`\^^G=\other
9186 \catcode`\^^H=\other
9187 \catcode`\^^K=\other
9188 \catcode`\^^L=\other
9189 \catcode`\^^N=\other
9190 \catcode`\^^P=\other
9191 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
9192 \catcode`\^^R=\other
9193 \catcode`\^^S=\other
9194 \catcode`\^^T=\other
9195 \catcode`\^^U=\other
9196 \catcode`\^^V=\other
9197 \catcode`\^^W=\other
9198 \catcode`\^^X=\other
9199 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
9200 \catcode`\^^[=\other
9201 \catcode`\^^\=\other
9202 \catcode`\^^]=\other
9203 \catcode`\^^^=\other
9204 \catcode`\^^_=\other
9205 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
9206 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
9207 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
9208 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
9209 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
9210 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
9211 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
9212 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
9214 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
9215 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
9216 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
9218 \catcode`\^=\other
9220 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
9221 \catcode`\~=\other
9222 \catcode`\[=\other
9223 \catcode`\]=\other
9224 \catcode`\"=\other
9225 \catcode`\_=\other
9226 \catcode`\|=\other
9227 \catcode`\<=\other
9228 \catcode`\>=\other
9229 \catcode`\$=\other
9230 \catcode`\#=\other
9231 \catcode`\&=\other
9232 \catcode`\%=\other
9233 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
9235 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
9236 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
9237 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
9238 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
9239 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
9240 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
9241 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
9242 \catcode`\\=\other
9244 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
9245 \catcode`\{=1
9246 \catcode`\}=2
9247 \catcode`\@=0
9250 \def\readdatafile#1{%
9251 \begingroup
9252 \setupdatafile
9253 \input\jobname.#1
9254 \endgroup}
9257 \message{insertions,}
9258 % including footnotes.
9260 \newcount \footnoteno
9262 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
9263 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
9264 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
9265 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
9266 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
9267 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
9269 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
9270 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
9272 {\catcode `\@=11
9274 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
9275 \gdef\footnote{%
9276 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
9277 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
9279 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
9280 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
9281 \let\@sf\empty
9282 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
9284 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
9285 \unskip
9286 \thisfootno\@sf
9287 \dofootnote
9290 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
9291 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
9293 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
9294 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
9295 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
9297 \gdef\dofootnote{%
9298 \insert\footins\bgroup
9300 % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
9301 % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
9302 \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest
9304 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
9305 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
9306 % So reset some parameters.
9307 \hsize=\txipagewidth
9308 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
9309 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
9310 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
9311 \floatingpenalty\@MM
9312 \leftskip\z@skip
9313 \rightskip\z@skip
9314 \spaceskip\z@skip
9315 \xspaceskip\z@skip
9316 \parindent\defaultparindent
9318 \smallfonts \rm
9320 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
9321 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
9322 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
9323 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
9324 \let\noindent = \relax
9326 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
9327 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
9328 \everypar = {\hang}%
9329 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
9331 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
9332 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
9333 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
9334 \footstrut
9336 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
9337 \futurelet\next\fo@t
9339 }%end \catcode `\@=11
9341 \def\errfootnotenest{%
9342 \errhelp=\EMsimple
9343 \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
9344 even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
9347 \def\errfootnoteheading{%
9348 \errhelp=\EMsimple
9349 \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported}
9352 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
9353 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
9354 % would be lost.
9355 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
9356 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
9357 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
9359 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
9360 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
9361 % out prematurely.
9363 \def\startsavinginserts{%
9364 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
9365 \let\insert\saveinsert
9366 \else
9367 \let\checkinserts\relax
9371 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
9372 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
9374 \def\saveinsert#1{%
9375 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
9376 \afterassignment\next
9377 % swallow the left brace
9378 \let\temp =
9380 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
9381 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
9383 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
9385 \def\placesaveins#1{%
9386 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
9387 {\box#1}%
9390 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
9392 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
9393 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
9396 % initialization:
9397 \def\newsaveins #1{%
9398 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
9399 \next
9401 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
9402 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
9403 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
9404 \checksaveins #1}%
9407 % initialize:
9408 \let\checkinserts\empty
9409 \newsaveins\footins
9410 \newsaveins\margin
9413 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
9414 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
9416 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
9417 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
9418 % undone and the next image would fail.
9419 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
9420 \ifeof 1 \else
9421 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
9422 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
9423 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
9424 \input epsf.tex
9426 \closein 1
9428 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
9429 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
9430 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
9431 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
9432 it from https://ctan.org/texarchive/macros/texinfo/texinfo/doc/epsf.tex.}
9434 \def\image#1{%
9435 \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
9436 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
9437 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
9438 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
9439 \global\warnednoepsftrue
9441 \else
9442 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
9446 % Arguments to @image:
9447 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
9448 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
9449 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
9450 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
9451 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
9452 \newif\ifimagevmode
9453 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
9454 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
9455 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
9456 \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}% in case we are being used via a macro
9457 % If the image is by itself, center it.
9458 \ifvmode
9459 \imagevmodetrue
9460 \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
9461 % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
9462 \imagevmodetrue
9463 \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
9464 \fi\fi
9466 \ifimagevmode
9467 \nobreak\medskip
9468 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
9469 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
9470 % above and below.
9471 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
9472 \nobreak
9475 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
9476 % environment such as @quotation is respected.
9477 % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
9478 % normal paragraph indentation.
9479 % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
9480 % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
9481 % eradicate the centering.
9482 \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
9484 % Output the image.
9485 \ifpdf
9486 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX <= 0.80
9487 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
9488 \else
9489 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9490 % For epsf.tex
9491 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
9492 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
9493 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
9494 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
9495 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
9496 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
9497 \else
9498 % For XeTeX
9499 \doxeteximage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
9503 \ifimagevmode
9504 \medskip % space after a standalone image
9506 \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
9507 \endgroup}
9510 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
9511 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
9512 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
9514 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
9516 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
9517 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
9519 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
9520 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
9521 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
9523 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
9524 % be referable.
9526 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
9527 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
9529 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
9530 % chapter-level command.
9531 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
9533 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
9534 \let\thiscaption=\empty
9535 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
9537 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
9539 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
9540 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
9542 \startsavinginserts
9544 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
9545 \par
9547 \vtop\bgroup
9548 \def\floattype{#1}%
9549 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
9550 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
9552 \ifx\floattype\empty
9553 \let\safefloattype=\empty
9554 \else
9556 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9557 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9558 \indexnofonts
9559 \turnoffactive
9560 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9564 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
9565 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9566 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
9567 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
9569 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
9570 \global\advance\floatno by 1
9573 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
9574 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
9575 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
9576 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
9577 % lists of floats.
9579 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
9580 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
9584 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
9585 \vskip\parskip
9587 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
9588 \restorefirstparagraphindent
9591 % we have these possibilities:
9592 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
9593 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
9594 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
9595 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
9596 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
9597 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
9598 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
9599 % @float & no caption:
9601 \def\Efloat{%
9602 \let\floatident = \empty
9604 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
9605 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
9607 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
9608 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9609 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
9610 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
9612 % the number.
9613 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9616 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
9617 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
9618 \let\captionline = \floatident
9620 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
9621 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
9622 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
9625 % caption text.
9626 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
9629 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
9630 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
9631 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
9632 \vskip.5\parskip
9633 \captionline
9635 % Space below caption.
9636 \vskip\parskip
9639 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
9640 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
9641 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9642 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
9643 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
9644 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
9646 \requireauxfile
9647 \atdummies
9649 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
9650 \def\gtemp{\thiscaption}%
9651 \else
9652 \def\gtemp{\thisshortcaption}%
9654 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
9655 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
9658 \egroup % end of \vtop
9660 \checkinserts
9663 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
9665 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
9666 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
9669 % @caption, @shortcaption
9671 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
9672 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
9673 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
9674 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
9676 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
9677 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
9678 \def\getfloatno#1{%
9679 \ifx#1\relax
9680 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
9681 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
9683 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
9684 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
9685 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
9687 \let\floatno#1%
9690 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
9691 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
9692 % first read the @float command.
9694 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9696 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
9697 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
9698 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
9700 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
9701 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
9702 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
9704 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
9706 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
9707 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
9709 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
9710 \def\temp{#1}%
9711 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
9712 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
9715 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
9717 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
9718 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
9720 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9721 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9722 \indexnofonts
9723 \turnoffactive
9724 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9727 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
9728 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
9729 \ifhavexrefs
9730 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
9731 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
9733 \else
9734 \begingroup
9735 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
9736 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
9737 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
9738 \endgroup
9742 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
9743 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
9744 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
9745 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
9747 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
9748 % they won't appear in the aux file).
9750 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
9751 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
9752 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
9753 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
9754 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
9755 % in pdf output.
9756 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
9758 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
9759 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
9760 \writeentry
9764 \message{localization,}
9766 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
9767 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
9768 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
9771 \catcode`\_ = \active
9772 \globaldefs=1
9773 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
9774 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
9775 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
9776 \let_ = \normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test
9777 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
9778 \ifeof 1
9779 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish
9780 \else
9781 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9782 \input txi-#1.tex
9784 \closein 1
9785 \endgroup % end raw TeX
9788 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
9789 % try txi-de.tex.
9791 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
9792 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
9793 \ifeof 1
9794 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
9795 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
9796 \else
9797 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9798 \input txi-#1.tex
9800 \closein 1
9802 }% end of special _ catcode
9804 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
9805 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
9806 directory should work if nowhere else does.}
9808 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
9809 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
9810 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
9812 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
9813 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
9814 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
9816 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
9817 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
9818 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
9819 % accented characters problem.)
9821 \catcode`@=11
9822 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
9823 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
9824 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
9825 \message{no patterns for #1}%
9826 \else
9827 \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
9829 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
9830 \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
9831 \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
9834 % XeTeX and LuaTeX can handle Unicode natively.
9835 % Their default I/O uses UTF-8 sequences instead of a byte-wise operation.
9836 % Other TeX engines' I/O (pdfTeX, etc.) is byte-wise.
9838 \newif\iftxinativeunicodecapable
9839 \newif\iftxiusebytewiseio
9841 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9842 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
9843 \txinativeunicodecapablefalse
9844 \txiusebytewiseiotrue
9845 \else
9846 \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
9847 \txiusebytewiseiofalse
9849 \else
9850 \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
9851 \txiusebytewiseiofalse
9854 % Set I/O by bytes instead of UTF-8 sequence for XeTeX and LuaTex
9855 % for non-UTF-8 (byte-wise) encodings.
9857 \def\setbytewiseio{%
9858 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9859 \else
9860 \XeTeXdefaultencoding "bytes" % For subsequent files to be read
9861 \XeTeXinputencoding "bytes" % For document root file
9862 % Unfortunately, there seems to be no corresponding XeTeX command for
9863 % output encoding. This is a problem for auxiliary index and TOC files.
9864 % The only solution would be perhaps to write out @U{...} sequences in
9865 % place of non-ASCII characters.
9868 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
9869 \else
9870 \directlua{
9871 local utf8_char, byte, gsub = unicode.utf8.char, string.byte, string.gsub
9872 local function convert_char (char)
9873 return utf8_char(byte(char))
9876 local function convert_line (line)
9877 return gsub(line, ".", convert_char)
9880 callback.register("process_input_buffer", convert_line)
9882 local function convert_line_out (line)
9883 local line_out = ""
9884 for c in string.utfvalues(line) do
9885 line_out = line_out .. string.char(c)
9887 return line_out
9890 callback.register("process_output_buffer", convert_line_out)
9894 \txiusebytewiseiotrue
9898 % Helpers for encodings.
9899 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
9901 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
9902 \count255=128
9903 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
9904 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
9905 \advance\count255 by 1
9906 \repeat
9909 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
9910 \count255=128
9911 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
9912 \catcode\count255=#1\relax
9913 \advance\count255 by 1
9914 \repeat
9917 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
9918 % according to the specified encoding.
9920 \def\documentencoding{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\documentencodingzzz}
9921 \def\documentencodingzzz#1{%
9923 % Encoding being declared for the document.
9924 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
9926 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
9927 % to compare them with \ifx.
9928 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
9929 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
9930 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
9931 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
9932 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
9934 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
9935 \asciichardefs
9937 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
9938 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9939 \setbytewiseio
9941 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9942 \lattwochardefs
9944 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
9945 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9946 \setbytewiseio
9948 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9949 \latonechardefs
9951 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
9952 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9953 \setbytewiseio
9955 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9956 \latninechardefs
9958 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
9959 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9960 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX)
9961 \nativeunicodechardefs
9962 \else
9963 % For treating UTF-8 as byte sequences (TeX, eTeX and pdfTeX)
9964 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9965 % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
9966 % (below), do not re-invoke it, otherwise our check for duplicated
9967 % definitions gets triggered. Making non-ascii chars active is
9968 % sufficient.
9971 \else
9972 \message{Ignoring unknown document encoding: #1.}%
9974 \fi % utfeight
9975 \fi % latnine
9976 \fi % latone
9977 \fi % lattwo
9978 \fi % ascii
9980 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9981 \else
9982 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
9983 \else
9984 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
9985 \else
9986 \message{Warning: XeTeX with non-UTF-8 encodings cannot handle %
9987 non-ASCII characters in auxiliary files.}%
9993 % emacs-page
9994 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
9995 % the default font encoding (OT1).
9997 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry: #1.}}
9999 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
10000 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
10002 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
10003 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
10004 % macros containing the character definitions.
10005 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
10008 \def\gdefchar#1#2{%
10009 \gdef#1{%
10010 \ifpassthroughchars
10011 \string#1%
10012 \else
10017 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
10018 \def\latonechardefs{%
10019 \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
10020 \gdefchar^^a1{\exclamdown}
10021 \gdefchar^^a2{{\tcfont \char162}} % cent
10022 \gdefchar^^a3{\pounds{}}
10023 \gdefchar^^a4{{\tcfont \char164}} % currency
10024 \gdefchar^^a5{{\tcfont \char165}} % yen
10025 \gdefchar^^a6{{\tcfont \char166}} % broken bar
10026 \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
10027 \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
10028 \gdefchar^^a9{\copyright{}}
10029 \gdefchar^^aa{\ordf}
10030 \gdefchar^^ab{\guillemetleft{}}
10031 \gdefchar^^ac{\ensuremath\lnot}
10032 \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
10033 \gdefchar^^ae{\registeredsymbol{}}
10034 \gdefchar^^af{\={}}
10036 \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree}
10037 \gdefchar^^b1{$\pm$}
10038 \gdefchar^^b2{$^2$}
10039 \gdefchar^^b3{$^3$}
10040 \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
10041 \gdefchar^^b5{$\mu$}
10042 \gdefchar^^b6{\P}
10043 \gdefchar^^b7{\ensuremath\cdot}
10044 \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
10045 \gdefchar^^b9{$^1$}
10046 \gdefchar^^ba{\ordm}
10047 \gdefchar^^bb{\guillemetright{}}
10048 \gdefchar^^bc{$1\over4$}
10049 \gdefchar^^bd{$1\over2$}
10050 \gdefchar^^be{$3\over4$}
10051 \gdefchar^^bf{\questiondown}
10053 \gdefchar^^c0{\`A}
10054 \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
10055 \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
10056 \gdefchar^^c3{\~A}
10057 \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
10058 \gdefchar^^c5{\ringaccent A}
10059 \gdefchar^^c6{\AE}
10060 \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
10061 \gdefchar^^c8{\`E}
10062 \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
10063 \gdefchar^^ca{\^E}
10064 \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
10065 \gdefchar^^cc{\`I}
10066 \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
10067 \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
10068 \gdefchar^^cf{\"I}
10070 \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
10071 \gdefchar^^d1{\~N}
10072 \gdefchar^^d2{\`O}
10073 \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
10074 \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
10075 \gdefchar^^d5{\~O}
10076 \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
10077 \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
10078 \gdefchar^^d8{\O}
10079 \gdefchar^^d9{\`U}
10080 \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
10081 \gdefchar^^db{\^U}
10082 \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
10083 \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
10084 \gdefchar^^de{\TH}
10085 \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
10087 \gdefchar^^e0{\`a}
10088 \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
10089 \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
10090 \gdefchar^^e3{\~a}
10091 \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
10092 \gdefchar^^e5{\ringaccent a}
10093 \gdefchar^^e6{\ae}
10094 \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
10095 \gdefchar^^e8{\`e}
10096 \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
10097 \gdefchar^^ea{\^e}
10098 \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
10099 \gdefchar^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
10100 \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
10101 \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
10102 \gdefchar^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
10104 \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
10105 \gdefchar^^f1{\~n}
10106 \gdefchar^^f2{\`o}
10107 \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
10108 \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
10109 \gdefchar^^f5{\~o}
10110 \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
10111 \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
10112 \gdefchar^^f8{\o}
10113 \gdefchar^^f9{\`u}
10114 \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
10115 \gdefchar^^fb{\^u}
10116 \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
10117 \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
10118 \gdefchar^^fe{\th}
10119 \gdefchar^^ff{\"y}
10122 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
10123 \def\latninechardefs{%
10124 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
10125 \latonechardefs
10127 \gdefchar^^a4{\euro{}}
10128 \gdefchar^^a6{\v S}
10129 \gdefchar^^a8{\v s}
10130 \gdefchar^^b4{\v Z}
10131 \gdefchar^^b8{\v z}
10132 \gdefchar^^bc{\OE}
10133 \gdefchar^^bd{\oe}
10134 \gdefchar^^be{\"Y}
10137 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
10138 \def\lattwochardefs{%
10139 \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
10140 \gdefchar^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
10141 \gdefchar^^a2{\u{}}
10142 \gdefchar^^a3{\L}
10143 \gdefchar^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
10144 \gdefchar^^a5{\v L}
10145 \gdefchar^^a6{\'S}
10146 \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
10147 \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
10148 \gdefchar^^a9{\v S}
10149 \gdefchar^^aa{\cedilla S}
10150 \gdefchar^^ab{\v T}
10151 \gdefchar^^ac{\'Z}
10152 \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
10153 \gdefchar^^ae{\v Z}
10154 \gdefchar^^af{\dotaccent Z}
10156 \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree{}}
10157 \gdefchar^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
10158 \gdefchar^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
10159 \gdefchar^^b3{\l}
10160 \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
10161 \gdefchar^^b5{\v l}
10162 \gdefchar^^b6{\'s}
10163 \gdefchar^^b7{\v{}}
10164 \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
10165 \gdefchar^^b9{\v s}
10166 \gdefchar^^ba{\cedilla s}
10167 \gdefchar^^bb{\v t}
10168 \gdefchar^^bc{\'z}
10169 \gdefchar^^bd{\H{}}
10170 \gdefchar^^be{\v z}
10171 \gdefchar^^bf{\dotaccent z}
10173 \gdefchar^^c0{\'R}
10174 \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
10175 \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
10176 \gdefchar^^c3{\u A}
10177 \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
10178 \gdefchar^^c5{\'L}
10179 \gdefchar^^c6{\'C}
10180 \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
10181 \gdefchar^^c8{\v C}
10182 \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
10183 \gdefchar^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
10184 \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
10185 \gdefchar^^cc{\v E}
10186 \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
10187 \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
10188 \gdefchar^^cf{\v D}
10190 \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
10191 \gdefchar^^d1{\'N}
10192 \gdefchar^^d2{\v N}
10193 \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
10194 \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
10195 \gdefchar^^d5{\H O}
10196 \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
10197 \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
10198 \gdefchar^^d8{\v R}
10199 \gdefchar^^d9{\ringaccent U}
10200 \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
10201 \gdefchar^^db{\H U}
10202 \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
10203 \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
10204 \gdefchar^^de{\cedilla T}
10205 \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
10207 \gdefchar^^e0{\'r}
10208 \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
10209 \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
10210 \gdefchar^^e3{\u a}
10211 \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
10212 \gdefchar^^e5{\'l}
10213 \gdefchar^^e6{\'c}
10214 \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
10215 \gdefchar^^e8{\v c}
10216 \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
10217 \gdefchar^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
10218 \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
10219 \gdefchar^^ec{\v e}
10220 \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
10221 \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
10222 \gdefchar^^ef{\v d}
10224 \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
10225 \gdefchar^^f1{\'n}
10226 \gdefchar^^f2{\v n}
10227 \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
10228 \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
10229 \gdefchar^^f5{\H o}
10230 \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
10231 \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
10232 \gdefchar^^f8{\v r}
10233 \gdefchar^^f9{\ringaccent u}
10234 \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
10235 \gdefchar^^fb{\H u}
10236 \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
10237 \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
10238 \gdefchar^^fe{\cedilla t}
10239 \gdefchar^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
10242 % UTF-8 character definitions.
10244 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
10245 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
10246 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
10248 \newcount\countUTFx
10249 \newcount\countUTFy
10250 \newcount\countUTFz
10252 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
10253 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
10255 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
10256 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
10258 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
10259 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
10261 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
10262 \ifx #1\relax
10263 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
10264 \else
10265 \expandafter #1%
10269 % Give non-ASCII bytes the active definitions for processing UTF-8 sequences
10270 \begingroup
10271 \catcode`\~13
10272 \catcode`\$12
10273 \catcode`\"12
10275 % Loop from \countUTFx to \countUTFy, performing \UTFviiiTmp
10276 % substituting ~ and $ with a character token of that value.
10277 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
10278 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
10279 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
10280 \uccode`\$\countUTFx
10281 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
10282 \advance\countUTFx by 1
10283 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
10284 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
10285 \fi}
10287 % For bytes other than the first in a UTF-8 sequence. Not expected to
10288 % be expanded except when writing to auxiliary files.
10289 \countUTFx = "80
10290 \countUTFy = "C2
10291 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10292 \gdef~{%
10293 \ifpassthroughchars $\fi}}%
10294 \UTFviiiLoop
10296 \countUTFx = "C2
10297 \countUTFy = "E0
10298 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10299 \gdef~{%
10300 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10301 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiTwoOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
10302 \UTFviiiLoop
10304 \countUTFx = "E0
10305 \countUTFy = "F0
10306 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10307 \gdef~{%
10308 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10309 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiThreeOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
10310 \UTFviiiLoop
10312 \countUTFx = "F0
10313 \countUTFy = "F4
10314 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10315 \gdef~{%
10316 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10317 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiFourOctets\expandafter$\fi
10319 \UTFviiiLoop
10320 \endgroup
10322 \def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
10324 % @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
10325 \def\U#1{%
10326 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax
10327 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
10328 % All Unicode characters can be used if native Unicode handling is
10329 % active. However, if the font does not have the glyph,
10330 % letters are missing.
10331 \begingroup
10332 \uccode`\.="#1\relax
10333 \uppercase{.}
10334 \endgroup
10335 \else
10336 \errhelp = \EMsimple
10337 \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}%
10339 \else
10340 \csname uni:#1\endcsname
10344 % These macros are used here to construct the name of a control
10345 % sequence to be defined.
10346 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName#1#2{%
10347 \csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}%
10348 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName#1#2#3{%
10349 \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}%
10350 \def\UTFviiiFourOctetsName#1#2#3#4{%
10351 \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}%
10353 % For UTF-8 byte sequences (TeX, e-TeX and pdfTeX),
10354 % provide a definition macro to replace a Unicode character;
10355 % this gets used by the @U command
10357 \begingroup
10358 \catcode`\"=12
10359 \catcode`\<=12
10360 \catcode`\.=12
10361 \catcode`\,=12
10362 \catcode`\;=12
10363 \catcode`\!=12
10364 \catcode`\~=13
10365 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii#1#2{%
10366 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
10367 \begingroup
10368 \parseXMLCharref
10370 % Give \u8:... its definition. The sequence of seven \expandafter's
10371 % expands after the \gdef three times, e.g.
10373 % 1. \UTFviiTwoOctetsName B1 B2
10374 % 2. \csname u8:B1 \string B2 \endcsname
10375 % 3. \u8: B1 B2 (a single control sequence token)
10377 \expandafter\expandafter
10378 \expandafter\expandafter
10379 \expandafter\expandafter
10380 \expandafter\gdef \UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
10382 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax \else
10383 \message{Internal error, already defined: #1}%
10386 % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
10387 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
10388 \endgroup}
10390 % Given the value in \countUTFz as a Unicode code point, set \UTFviiiTmp
10391 % to the corresponding UTF-8 sequence.
10392 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
10393 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
10394 \errhelp = \EMsimple
10395 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
10396 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
10397 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10398 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName.,%
10399 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
10400 \parseUTFviiiA;%
10401 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10402 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName.{,;}%
10403 \else
10404 \parseUTFviiiA;%
10405 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10406 \parseUTFviiiA!%
10407 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctetsName.{!,;}%
10408 \fi\fi\fi
10411 % Extract a byte from the end of the UTF-8 representation of \countUTFx.
10412 % It must be a non-initial byte in the sequence.
10413 % Change \uccode of #1 for it to be used in \parseUTFviiiB as one
10414 % of the bytes.
10415 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
10416 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
10417 \divide\countUTFz by 64
10418 \countUTFy = \countUTFz % Save to be the future value of \countUTFz.
10419 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
10421 % \countUTFz is now \countUTFx with the last 5 bits cleared. Subtract
10422 % in order to get the last five bits.
10423 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
10425 % Convert this to the byte in the UTF-8 sequence.
10426 \advance\countUTFx by 128
10427 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
10428 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
10430 % Used to put a UTF-8 byte sequence into \UTFviiiTmp
10431 % #1 is the increment for \countUTFz to yield a the first byte of the UTF-8
10432 % sequence.
10433 % #2 is one of the \UTFviii*OctetsName macros.
10434 % #3 is always a full stop (.)
10435 % #4 is a template for the other bytes in the sequence. The values for these
10436 % bytes is substituted in here with \uppercase using the \uccode's.
10437 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
10438 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
10439 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
10440 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
10441 \endgroup
10443 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
10444 % provide a definition macro that sets a catcode to `other' non-globally
10446 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeOther#1#2{%
10447 \catcode"#1=\other
10450 % https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
10451 % U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
10452 % U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
10453 % U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
10454 % U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
10456 % Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
10457 % characters are available somewhere. Loading the necessary fonts
10458 % awaits user request. We can't truly support Unicode without
10459 % reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
10460 % plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
10461 % We won't be doing that here in this simple file. But we can try to at
10462 % least make most of the characters not bomb out.
10464 \def\unicodechardefs{%
10465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}%
10466 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}%
10467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A2}{{\tcfont \char162}}% 0242=cent
10468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds{}}%
10469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A4}{{\tcfont \char164}}% 0244=currency
10470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A5}{{\tcfont \char165}}% 0245=yen
10471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A6}{{\tcfont \char166}}% 0246=brokenbar
10472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7}{\S}%
10473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}%
10474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright{}}%
10475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}%
10476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft{}}%
10477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC}{\ensuremath\lnot}%
10478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}%
10479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol{}}%
10480 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}%
10482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}%
10483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1}{\ensuremath\pm}%
10484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2}{$^2$}%
10485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3}{$^3$}%
10486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}%
10487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5}{$\mu$}%
10488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6}{\P}%
10489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
10490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}%
10491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9}{$^1$}%
10492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}%
10493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright{}}%
10494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC}{$1\over4$}%
10495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD}{$1\over2$}%
10496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE}{$3\over4$}%
10497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}%
10499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}%
10500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}%
10501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}%
10502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}%
10503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}%
10504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}%
10505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}%
10506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}%
10507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}%
10508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}%
10509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}%
10510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}%
10511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}%
10512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}%
10513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}%
10514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}%
10516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}%
10517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}%
10518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}%
10519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}%
10520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}%
10521 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}%
10522 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}%
10523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7}{\ensuremath\times}%
10524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}%
10525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}%
10526 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}%
10527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}%
10528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}%
10529 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}%
10530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}%
10531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}%
10533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}%
10534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}%
10535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}%
10536 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}%
10537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}%
10538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}%
10539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}%
10540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}%
10541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}%
10542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}%
10543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}%
10544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}%
10545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}%
10546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}%
10547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}%
10548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}%
10550 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}%
10551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}%
10552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}%
10553 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}%
10554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}%
10555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}%
10556 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}%
10557 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7}{\ensuremath\div}%
10558 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}%
10559 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}%
10560 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}%
10561 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}%
10562 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}%
10563 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}%
10564 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}%
10565 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}%
10567 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}%
10568 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}%
10569 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}%
10570 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}%
10571 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}%
10572 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}%
10573 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}%
10574 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}%
10575 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}%
10576 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}%
10577 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}%
10578 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}%
10579 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}%
10580 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}%
10581 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}%
10582 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F}{d'}%
10584 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}%
10585 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}%
10586 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}%
10587 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}%
10588 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}%
10589 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}%
10590 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}%
10591 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}%
10592 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}%
10593 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}%
10594 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}%
10595 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}%
10596 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}%
10597 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}%
10598 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}%
10599 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}%
10601 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}%
10602 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}%
10603 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G}}%
10604 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g}}%
10605 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}%
10606 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}%
10607 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
10608 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
10609 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}%
10610 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}%
10611 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}%
10612 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}%
10613 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}%
10614 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}%
10615 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E}{\ogonek{I}}%
10616 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F}{\ogonek{i}}%
10618 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}%
10619 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}%
10620 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}%
10621 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}%
10622 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}%
10623 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}%
10624 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K}}%
10625 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k}}%
10626 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
10627 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}%
10628 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}%
10629 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B}{\cedilla{L}}%
10630 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C}{\cedilla{l}}%
10631 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D}{L'}% should kern
10632 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E}{l'}% should kern
10633 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F}{L\U{00B7}}%
10635 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l\U{00B7}}%
10636 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}%
10637 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}%
10638 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}%
10639 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}%
10640 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N}}%
10641 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n}}%
10642 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}%
10643 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}%
10644 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n}%
10645 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A}{\missingcharmsg{ENG}}%
10646 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B}{\missingcharmsg{eng}}%
10647 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}%
10648 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}%
10649 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}%
10650 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}%
10652 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}%
10653 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}%
10654 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}%
10655 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}%
10656 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}%
10657 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}%
10658 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R}}%
10659 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r}}%
10660 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}%
10661 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}%
10662 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}%
10663 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}%
10664 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}%
10665 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}%
10666 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}%
10667 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}%
10669 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}%
10670 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}%
10671 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T}}%
10672 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t}}%
10673 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}%
10674 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t}}%
10675 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
10676 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
10677 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}%
10678 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}%
10679 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}%
10680 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}%
10681 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}%
10682 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}%
10683 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}%
10684 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}%
10686 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}%
10687 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}%
10688 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U}}%
10689 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u}}%
10690 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}%
10691 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}%
10692 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}%
10693 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}%
10694 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}%
10695 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}%
10696 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}%
10697 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}%
10698 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}%
10699 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}%
10700 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}%
10701 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S}}%
10703 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}%
10704 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}%
10705 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}%
10706 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}%
10707 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}%
10708 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}%
10709 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}%
10710 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}%
10711 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}%
10712 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}%
10713 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}%
10714 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}%
10716 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}%
10717 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}%
10718 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}%
10719 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}%
10720 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}%
10722 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}%
10723 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}%
10724 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}%
10725 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}%
10726 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}%
10727 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}%
10729 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}%
10730 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}%
10731 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}%
10732 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}%
10733 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}%
10734 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}%
10735 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}%
10736 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}%
10737 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}%
10738 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}%
10739 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}%
10740 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}%
10742 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}%
10743 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}%
10745 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}%
10746 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}%
10747 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}%
10748 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}%
10749 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}%
10750 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}%
10752 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}%
10753 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}%
10754 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}%
10756 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}%
10758 % Greek letters upper case
10759 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0391}{{\it A}}%
10760 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0392}{{\it B}}%
10761 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0393}{\ensuremath{\mit\Gamma}}%
10762 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0394}{\ensuremath{\mit\Delta}}%
10763 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0395}{{\it E}}%
10764 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0396}{{\it Z}}%
10765 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0397}{{\it H}}%
10766 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0398}{\ensuremath{\mit\Theta}}%
10767 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0399}{{\it I}}%
10768 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039A}{{\it K}}%
10769 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039B}{\ensuremath{\mit\Lambda}}%
10770 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039C}{{\it M}}%
10771 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039D}{{\it N}}%
10772 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039E}{\ensuremath{\mit\Xi}}%
10773 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039F}{{\it O}}%
10774 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A0}{\ensuremath{\mit\Pi}}%
10775 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A1}{{\it P}}%
10776 %\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A2}{} % none - corresponds to final sigma
10777 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A3}{\ensuremath{\mit\Sigma}}%
10778 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A4}{{\it T}}%
10779 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A5}{\ensuremath{\mit\Upsilon}}%
10780 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A6}{\ensuremath{\mit\Phi}}%
10781 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A7}{{\it X}}%
10782 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A8}{\ensuremath{\mit\Psi}}%
10783 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A9}{\ensuremath{\mit\Omega}}%
10785 % Vowels with accents
10786 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0390}{\ensuremath{\ddot{\acute\iota}}}%
10787 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AC}{\ensuremath{\acute\alpha}}%
10788 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AD}{\ensuremath{\acute\epsilon}}%
10789 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AE}{\ensuremath{\acute\eta}}%
10790 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AF}{\ensuremath{\acute\iota}}%
10791 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B0}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ddot\upsilon}}}%
10793 % Standalone accent
10794 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0384}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ }}}%
10796 % Greek letters lower case
10797 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B1}{\ensuremath\alpha}%
10798 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B2}{\ensuremath\beta}%
10799 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B3}{\ensuremath\gamma}%
10800 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B4}{\ensuremath\delta}%
10801 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B5}{\ensuremath\epsilon}%
10802 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B6}{\ensuremath\zeta}%
10803 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B7}{\ensuremath\eta}%
10804 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B8}{\ensuremath\theta}%
10805 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B9}{\ensuremath\iota}%
10806 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BA}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
10807 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BB}{\ensuremath\lambda}%
10808 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BC}{\ensuremath\mu}%
10809 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BD}{\ensuremath\nu}%
10810 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BE}{\ensuremath\xi}%
10811 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BF}{{\it o}}% omicron
10812 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C0}{\ensuremath\pi}%
10813 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C1}{\ensuremath\rho}%
10814 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C2}{\ensuremath\varsigma}%
10815 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C3}{\ensuremath\sigma}%
10816 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C4}{\ensuremath\tau}%
10817 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C5}{\ensuremath\upsilon}%
10818 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C6}{\ensuremath\phi}%
10819 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C7}{\ensuremath\chi}%
10820 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C8}{\ensuremath\psi}%
10821 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C9}{\ensuremath\omega}%
10823 % More Greek vowels with accents
10824 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CA}{\ensuremath{\ddot\iota}}%
10825 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CB}{\ensuremath{\ddot\upsilon}}%
10826 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CC}{\ensuremath{\acute o}}%
10827 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CD}{\ensuremath{\acute\upsilon}}%
10828 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CE}{\ensuremath{\acute\omega}}%
10830 % Variant Greek letters
10831 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D1}{\ensuremath\vartheta}%
10832 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D6}{\ensuremath\varpi}%
10833 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03F1}{\ensuremath\varrho}%
10835 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}%
10836 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}%
10837 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}%
10838 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}%
10839 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}%
10840 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}%
10841 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}%
10842 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}%
10843 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}%
10844 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}%
10845 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}%
10846 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}%
10848 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}%
10849 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}%
10851 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}%
10852 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}%
10853 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}%
10854 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}%
10855 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}%
10856 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}%
10857 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}%
10858 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}%
10860 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}%
10861 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}%
10862 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}%
10863 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}%
10864 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}%
10865 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}%
10866 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}%
10867 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}%
10868 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}%
10869 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}%
10870 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}%
10871 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}%
10873 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}%
10874 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}%
10875 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}%
10876 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}%
10877 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}%
10878 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}%
10879 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}%
10880 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}%
10881 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}%
10882 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}%
10884 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}%
10885 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}%
10886 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}%
10887 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}%
10888 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}%
10889 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}%
10890 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}%
10891 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}%
10892 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}%
10893 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}%
10895 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}%
10896 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}%
10897 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}%
10898 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}%
10899 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}%
10900 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}%
10901 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}%
10902 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}%
10903 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}%
10904 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}%
10906 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}%
10907 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}%
10908 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}%
10909 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}%
10911 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}%
10912 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}%
10913 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}%
10914 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}%
10915 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}%
10916 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}%
10917 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}%
10918 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}%
10919 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}%
10920 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}%
10921 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}%
10922 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}%
10923 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}%
10924 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}%
10925 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}%
10926 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}%
10928 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}%
10929 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}%
10930 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}%
10931 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}%
10932 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}%
10933 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}%
10934 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}%
10935 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}%
10936 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}%
10937 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}%
10939 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}%
10940 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}%
10942 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}%
10943 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}%
10944 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}%
10945 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}%
10947 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}%
10948 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}%
10949 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}%
10950 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}%
10952 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}%
10953 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}%
10955 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}%
10956 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}%
10957 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}%
10959 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}%
10960 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}%
10962 % Punctuation
10963 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}%
10964 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}%
10965 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft{}}%
10966 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright{}}%
10967 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase{}}%
10968 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft{}}%
10969 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright{}}%
10970 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase{}}%
10971 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}%
10972 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}%
10973 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet{}}%
10974 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{202F}{\thinspace}%
10975 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots{}}%
10976 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft{}}%
10977 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright{}}%
10979 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro{}}%
10981 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion{}}%
10982 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result{}}%
10984 % Mathematical symbols
10985 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2200}{\ensuremath\forall}%
10986 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2203}{\ensuremath\exists}%
10987 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2208}{\ensuremath\in}%
10988 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus{}}%
10989 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\ast}%
10990 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221E}{\ensuremath\infty}%
10991 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}%
10992 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2227}{\ensuremath\wedge}%
10993 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2229}{\ensuremath\cap}%
10994 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv{}}%
10995 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2264}{\ensuremath\leq}%
10996 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2265}{\ensuremath\geq}%
10997 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2282}{\ensuremath\subset}%
10998 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2287}{\ensuremath\supseteq}%
11000 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2016}{\ensuremath\Vert}%
11001 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2032}{\ensuremath\prime}%
11002 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{210F}{\ensuremath\hbar}%
11003 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2111}{\ensuremath\Im}%
11004 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2113}{\ensuremath\ell}%
11005 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2118}{\ensuremath\wp}%
11006 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{211C}{\ensuremath\Re}%
11007 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2135}{\ensuremath\aleph}%
11008 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2190}{\ensuremath\leftarrow}%
11009 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2191}{\ensuremath\uparrow}%
11010 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2193}{\ensuremath\downarrow}%
11011 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2194}{\ensuremath\leftrightarrow}%
11012 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2195}{\ensuremath\updownarrow}%
11013 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2196}{\ensuremath\nwarrow}%
11014 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2197}{\ensuremath\nearrow}%
11015 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2198}{\ensuremath\searrow}%
11016 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2199}{\ensuremath\swarrow}%
11017 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A6}{\ensuremath\mapsto}%
11018 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A9}{\ensuremath\hookleftarrow}%
11019 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21AA}{\ensuremath\hookrightarrow}%
11020 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BC}{\ensuremath\leftharpoonup}%
11021 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BD}{\ensuremath\leftharpoondown}%
11022 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C0}{\ensuremath\rightharpoonup}%
11023 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C1}{\ensuremath\rightharpoondown}%
11024 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21CC}{\ensuremath\rightleftharpoons}%
11025 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D0}{\ensuremath\Leftarrow}%
11026 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D1}{\ensuremath\Uparrow}%
11027 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D3}{\ensuremath\Downarrow}%
11028 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D4}{\ensuremath\Leftrightarrow}%
11029 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D5}{\ensuremath\Updownarrow}%
11030 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2202}{\ensuremath\partial}%
11031 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2205}{\ensuremath\emptyset}%
11032 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2207}{\ensuremath\nabla}%
11033 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2209}{\ensuremath\notin}%
11034 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220B}{\ensuremath\owns}%
11035 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220F}{\ensuremath\prod}%
11036 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2210}{\ensuremath\coprod}%
11037 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2211}{\ensuremath\sum}%
11038 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2213}{\ensuremath\mp}%
11039 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2218}{\ensuremath\circ}%
11040 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221A}{\ensuremath\surd}%
11041 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221D}{\ensuremath\propto}%
11042 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2220}{\ensuremath\angle}%
11043 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2223}{\ensuremath\mid}%
11044 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2228}{\ensuremath\vee}%
11045 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222A}{\ensuremath\cup}%
11046 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222B}{\ensuremath\smallint}%
11047 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222E}{\ensuremath\oint}%
11048 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{223C}{\ensuremath\sim}%
11049 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2240}{\ensuremath\wr}%
11050 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2243}{\ensuremath\simeq}%
11051 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2245}{\ensuremath\cong}%
11052 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2248}{\ensuremath\approx}%
11053 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{224D}{\ensuremath\asymp}%
11054 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2250}{\ensuremath\doteq}%
11055 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2260}{\ensuremath\neq}%
11056 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226A}{\ensuremath\ll}%
11057 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226B}{\ensuremath\gg}%
11058 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227A}{\ensuremath\prec}%
11059 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227B}{\ensuremath\succ}%
11060 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2283}{\ensuremath\supset}%
11061 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2286}{\ensuremath\subseteq}%
11062 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228E}{\ensuremath\uplus}%
11063 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2291}{\ensuremath\sqsubseteq}%
11064 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2292}{\ensuremath\sqsupseteq}%
11065 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2293}{\ensuremath\sqcap}%
11066 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2294}{\ensuremath\sqcup}%
11067 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2295}{\ensuremath\oplus}%
11068 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2296}{\ensuremath\ominus}%
11069 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2297}{\ensuremath\otimes}%
11070 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2298}{\ensuremath\oslash}%
11071 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2299}{\ensuremath\odot}%
11072 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A2}{\ensuremath\vdash}%
11073 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A3}{\ensuremath\dashv}%
11074 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A4}{\ensuremath\ptextop}%
11075 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A5}{\ensuremath\bot}%
11076 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A8}{\ensuremath\models}%
11077 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C0}{\ensuremath\bigwedge}%
11078 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C1}{\ensuremath\bigvee}%
11079 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C2}{\ensuremath\bigcap}%
11080 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C3}{\ensuremath\bigcup}%
11081 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C4}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
11082 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C5}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
11083 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C6}{\ensuremath\star}%
11084 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C8}{\ensuremath\bowtie}%
11085 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2308}{\ensuremath\lceil}%
11086 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2309}{\ensuremath\rceil}%
11087 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230A}{\ensuremath\lfloor}%
11088 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230B}{\ensuremath\rfloor}%
11089 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2322}{\ensuremath\frown}%
11090 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2323}{\ensuremath\smile}%
11092 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B3}{\ensuremath\triangle}%
11093 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B7}{\ensuremath\triangleright}%
11094 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25BD}{\ensuremath\bigtriangledown}%
11095 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C1}{\ensuremath\triangleleft}%
11096 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C7}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
11097 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2660}{\ensuremath\spadesuit}%
11098 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2661}{\ensuremath\heartsuit}%
11099 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2662}{\ensuremath\diamondsuit}%
11100 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2663}{\ensuremath\clubsuit}%
11101 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266D}{\ensuremath\flat}%
11102 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266E}{\ensuremath\natural}%
11103 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266F}{\ensuremath\sharp}%
11104 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{26AA}{\ensuremath\bigcirc}%
11105 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27B9}{\ensuremath\rangle}%
11106 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27C2}{\ensuremath\perp}%
11107 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27E8}{\ensuremath\langle}%
11108 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F5}{\ensuremath\longleftarrow}%
11109 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F6}{\ensuremath\longrightarrow}%
11110 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F7}{\ensuremath\longleftrightarrow}%
11111 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27FC}{\ensuremath\longmapsto}%
11112 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{29F5}{\ensuremath\setminus}%
11113 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A00}{\ensuremath\bigodot}%
11114 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A01}{\ensuremath\bigoplus}%
11115 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A02}{\ensuremath\bigotimes}%
11116 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A04}{\ensuremath\biguplus}%
11117 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A06}{\ensuremath\bigsqcup}%
11118 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A3F}{\ensuremath\amalg}%
11119 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AAF}{\ensuremath\preceq}%
11120 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AB0}{\ensuremath\succeq}%
11122 \global\mathchardef\checkmark="1370% actually the square root sign
11123 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2713}{\ensuremath\checkmark}%
11124 }% end of \unicodechardefs
11126 % UTF-8 byte sequence (pdfTeX) definitions (replacing and @U command)
11127 % It makes the setting that replace UTF-8 byte sequence.
11128 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
11129 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii
11130 \unicodechardefs
11133 % Whether the active definitions of non-ASCII characters expand to
11134 % non-active tokens with the same character code. This is used to
11135 % write characters literally, instead of using active definitions for
11136 % printing the correct glyphs.
11137 \newif\ifpassthroughchars
11138 \passthroughcharsfalse
11140 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
11141 % provide a definition macro to replace/pass-through a Unicode character
11143 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative#1#2{%
11144 \catcode"#1=\active
11145 \def\dodeclareunicodecharacternative##1##2##3{%
11146 \begingroup
11147 \uccode`\~="##2\relax
11148 \uppercase{\gdef~}{%
11149 \ifpassthroughchars
11150 ##1%
11151 \else
11152 ##3%
11155 \endgroup
11157 \begingroup
11158 \uccode`\.="#1\relax
11159 \uppercase{\def\UTFNativeTmp{.}}%
11160 \expandafter\dodeclareunicodecharacternative\UTFNativeTmp{#1}{#2}%
11161 \endgroup
11164 % Native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX) character replacing definition.
11165 % It activates the setting that replaces Unicode characters.
11166 \def\nativeunicodechardefs{%
11167 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative
11168 \unicodechardefs
11171 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
11172 % make the character token expand
11173 % to the sequences given in \unicodechardefs for printing.
11174 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU#1#2{%
11175 \def\UTFAtUTmp{#2}
11176 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFAtUTmp
11179 % @U command definitions for native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX).
11180 \def\nativeunicodechardefsatu{%
11181 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU
11182 \unicodechardefs
11185 % US-ASCII character definitions.
11186 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
11187 \relax
11190 % define all Unicode characters we know about, for the sake of @U.
11191 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
11192 \nativeunicodechardefsatu
11193 \else
11194 \utfeightchardefs
11198 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
11199 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
11200 % document encoding.
11202 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
11205 \message{formatting,}
11207 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
11209 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
11210 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
11211 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
11213 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
11214 \vbadness = 10000
11216 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
11217 \hbadness = 6666
11219 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
11220 \widowpenalty=10000
11221 \clubpenalty=10000
11223 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
11224 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
11225 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
11226 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
11228 \def\setemergencystretch{%
11229 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
11230 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
11231 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
11232 \else
11233 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
11237 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
11238 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
11239 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
11241 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
11242 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
11244 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
11245 \voffset = #3\relax
11246 \topskip = #6\relax
11247 \splittopskip = \topskip
11249 \vsize = #1\relax
11250 \advance\vsize by \topskip
11251 \outervsize = \vsize
11252 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
11253 \txipageheight = \vsize
11255 \hsize = #2\relax
11256 \outerhsize = \hsize
11257 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
11258 \txipagewidth = \hsize
11260 \normaloffset = #4\relax
11261 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
11263 \ifpdf
11264 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
11265 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
11266 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
11267 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
11268 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
11269 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
11270 \else
11271 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
11272 \special{papersize=#8,#7}%
11273 \else
11274 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
11275 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
11276 % XeTeX does not have \pdfhorigin and \pdfvorigin.
11280 \setleading{\textleading}
11282 \parindent = \defaultparindent
11283 \setemergencystretch
11286 % @letterpaper (the default).
11287 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11288 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11289 \textleading = 13.2pt
11291 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
11292 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
11293 {\voffset}{.25in}%
11294 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
11295 {11in}{8.5in}%
11298 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
11299 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
11300 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
11301 \textleading = 12pt
11303 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
11304 {-.2in}{0in}%
11305 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
11306 {9.25in}{7in}%
11308 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
11309 \tolerance = 700
11310 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11311 \defbodyindent = .5cm
11314 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
11315 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
11316 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
11317 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
11318 \textleading = 12pt
11320 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
11321 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
11322 {0pt}{14pt}%
11323 {9in}{6in}%
11325 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
11326 \tolerance = 700
11327 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11328 \defbodyindent = .4cm
11331 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
11332 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11333 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11334 \textleading = 13.2pt
11336 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
11337 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
11338 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
11339 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
11340 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
11341 % your texinfo source file like this:
11342 % @tex
11343 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
11344 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
11345 % @end tex
11346 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
11347 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
11348 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
11349 {297mm}{210mm}%
11351 \tolerance = 700
11352 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11353 \defbodyindent = 5mm
11356 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
11357 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
11358 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
11359 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11360 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
11361 \textleading = 12.5pt
11363 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
11364 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
11365 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
11366 {210mm}{148mm}%
11368 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
11369 \tolerance = 800
11370 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11371 \defbodyindent = 2mm
11372 \tableindent = 12mm
11375 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
11376 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
11377 \afourpaper
11378 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
11379 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
11380 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
11381 {297mm}{210mm}%
11383 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
11384 \globaldefs = 0
11387 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
11388 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
11389 \afourpaper
11390 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
11391 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
11392 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
11393 {297mm}{210mm}%
11394 \globaldefs = 0
11397 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
11398 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
11399 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
11401 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
11402 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
11403 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
11404 \globaldefs = 1
11406 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11407 \setleading{\textleading}%
11409 \dimen0 = #1\relax
11410 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
11411 \advance\dimen0 by 1in % reference point for DVI is 1 inch from top of page
11413 \dimen2 = \hsize
11414 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
11415 \advance\dimen2 by 1in % reference point is 1 inch from left edge of page
11417 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
11418 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
11419 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
11420 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
11423 % Set default to letter.
11425 \letterpaper
11427 % Default value of \hfuzz, for suppressing warnings about overfull hboxes.
11428 \hfuzz = 1pt
11431 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
11433 \def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
11435 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
11436 \catcode`\^^? = 14
11438 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
11439 \catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
11440 \catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
11441 \catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
11442 \catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
11443 \catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
11444 \catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
11445 \catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
11446 \catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
11447 \catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
11449 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
11450 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
11451 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
11453 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
11454 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
11455 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
11456 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
11458 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
11460 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
11461 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
11462 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
11463 % this is not a problem.
11464 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
11466 % Set catcodes for Texinfo file
11468 % Active characters for printing the wanted glyph.
11469 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
11470 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
11472 \catcode`\"=\active
11473 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
11474 \let"=\activedoublequote
11475 \catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
11476 \chardef\hatchar=`\^
11477 \catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hatchar}} \let^ = \activehat
11479 \catcode`\_=\active
11480 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
11481 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
11482 \let\realunder=_
11484 \catcode`\|=\active \def|{{\tt\char124}}
11486 \chardef \less=`\<
11487 \catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
11488 \chardef \gtr=`\>
11489 \catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
11490 \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
11491 \catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
11492 \catcode`\-=\active \let-=\normaldash
11495 % used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
11496 % breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
11497 \def\texinfochars{%
11498 \let< = \activeless
11499 \let> = \activegtr
11500 \let~ = \activetilde
11501 \let^ = \activehat
11502 \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
11503 \let\b = \strong
11504 \let\i = \smartitalic
11505 % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
11508 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
11509 % parsing them.
11510 \def\turnoffactive{%
11511 \normalturnoffactive
11512 \otherbackslash
11515 \catcode`\@=0
11517 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
11518 % as in \char`\\.
11519 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
11520 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
11522 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
11523 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
11524 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
11526 % In Texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
11527 % in fixed width font.
11528 \catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on.
11530 % Print a typewriter backslash. For math mode, we can't simply use
11531 % \backslashcurfont: the story here is that in math mode, the \char
11532 % of \backslashcurfont ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol
11533 % font (because \char in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex
11534 % sets \mathcode`\\="026E). Hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
11535 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
11536 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
11537 % usual hex value because it has already been made active.
11539 @def@ttbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
11540 @let@backslashchar = @ttbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
11542 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
11543 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
11544 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
11545 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
11546 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
11548 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
11549 % the literal character `\'.
11551 {@catcode`- = @active
11552 @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
11553 @passthroughcharstrue
11554 @let-=@normaldash
11555 @let"=@normaldoublequote
11556 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
11557 @let+=@normalplus
11558 @let<=@normalless
11559 @let>=@normalgreater
11560 @let^=@normalcaret
11561 @let_=@normalunderscore
11562 @let|=@normalverticalbar
11563 @let~=@normaltilde
11564 @let\=@ttbackslash
11565 @markupsetuplqdefault
11566 @markupsetuprqdefault
11567 @unsepspaces
11571 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
11572 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
11573 % So turn them off again, and have @fixbackslash turn them back on.
11574 @catcode`+=@other @catcode`@_=@other
11576 % \enablebackslashhack - allow file to begin `\input texinfo'
11578 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
11579 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
11580 % a backslash.
11581 % If the file did not have a `\input texinfo', then it is turned off after
11582 % the first line; otherwise the first `\' in the file would cause an error.
11583 % This is used on the very last line of this file, texinfo.tex.
11584 % We also use @c to call @fixbackslash, in case ends of lines are hidden.
11586 @catcode`@^=7
11587 @catcode`@^^M=13@gdef@enablebackslashhack{%
11588 @global@let\ = @eatinput%
11589 @catcode`@^^M=13%
11590 @def@c{@fixbackslash@c}%
11591 % Definition for the newline at the end of this file.
11592 @def ^^M{@let^^M@secondlinenl}%
11593 % Definition for a newline in the main Texinfo file.
11594 @gdef @secondlinenl{@fixbackslash}%
11595 % In case the first line has a whole-line command on it
11596 @let@originalparsearg@parsearg
11597 @def@parsearg{@fixbackslash@originalparsearg}
11600 {@catcode`@^=7 @catcode`@^^M=13%
11601 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo#1^^M{@fixbackslash}}
11603 % Emergency active definition of newline, in case an active newline token
11604 % appears by mistake.
11605 {@catcode`@^=7 @catcode13=13%
11606 @gdef@enableemergencynewline{%
11607 @gdef^^M{%
11608 @par%
11609 %<warning: active newline>@par%
11613 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
11614 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @ttbackslash @fi
11615 @catcode13=5 % regular end of line
11616 @enableemergencynewline
11617 @let@c=@texinfoc
11618 @let@parsearg@originalparsearg
11619 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
11620 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
11621 @catcode`+=@active
11622 @catcode`@_=@active
11624 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
11625 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. This macro, @fixbackslash, gets
11626 % called at the beginning of every Texinfo file. Not opening texinfo.cnf
11627 % directly in this file, texinfo.tex, makes it possible to make a format
11628 % file for Texinfo.
11630 @openin 1 texinfo.cnf
11631 @ifeof 1 @else @input texinfo.cnf @fi
11632 @closein 1
11636 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
11637 @escapechar = `@@
11639 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
11640 % active definitions as the normal characters.
11641 @def@normaldot{.}
11642 @def@normalquest{?}
11643 @def@normalslash{/}
11645 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
11646 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
11647 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
11648 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
11649 @catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
11651 @let @hashchar = @normalhash
11653 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
11654 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
11655 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
11656 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
11657 @catcode`@'=@active
11658 @catcode`@`=@active
11659 @markupsetuplqdefault
11660 @markupsetuprqdefault
11662 @c Local variables:
11663 @c eval: (add-hook 'before-save-hook 'time-stamp)
11664 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message\\|emacs-page"
11665 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
11666 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
11667 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
11668 @c End:
11670 @c vim:sw=2:
11672 @enablebackslashhack